1 //===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements the ASTContext interface. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 15 #include "CXXABI.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/APValue.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/Decl.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h" 29 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 30 #include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h" 31 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 32 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 33 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h" 34 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h" 35 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h" 36 #include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h" 37 #include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h" 38 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h" 39 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 40 #include "clang/AST/Stmt.h" 41 #include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h" 42 #include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h" 43 #include "clang/AST/Type.h" 44 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 45 #include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h" 46 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h" 47 #include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h" 48 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 49 #include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h" 50 #include "clang/Basic/ExceptionSpecificationType.h" 51 #include "clang/Basic/FixedPoint.h" 52 #include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h" 53 #include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h" 54 #include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h" 55 #include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h" 56 #include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h" 57 #include "clang/Basic/SanitizerBlacklist.h" 58 #include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h" 59 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 60 #include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h" 61 #include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h" 62 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 63 #include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h" 64 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h" 65 #include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h" 66 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h" 67 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h" 68 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 69 #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h" 70 #include "llvm/ADT/None.h" 71 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 72 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h" 73 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 74 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 75 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h" 76 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h" 77 #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h" 78 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 79 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h" 80 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h" 81 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h" 82 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h" 83 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h" 84 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 85 #include <algorithm> 86 #include <cassert> 87 #include <cstddef> 88 #include <cstdint> 89 #include <cstdlib> 90 #include <map> 91 #include <memory> 92 #include <string> 93 #include <tuple> 94 #include <utility> 95 96 using namespace clang; 97 98 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors; 99 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared; 100 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors; 101 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared; 102 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors; 103 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared; 104 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators; 105 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared; 106 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators; 107 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared; 108 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors; 109 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared; 110 111 enum FloatingRank { 112 Float16Rank, HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank 113 }; 114 115 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const { 116 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) { 117 ExternalSource->ReadComments(); 118 119 #ifndef NDEBUG 120 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments(); 121 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 122 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr))); 123 #endif 124 125 CommentsLoaded = true; 126 } 127 128 assert(D); 129 130 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations. 131 if (D->isImplicit()) 132 return nullptr; 133 134 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations. 135 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 136 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 137 return nullptr; 138 } 139 140 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 141 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 142 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 143 return nullptr; 144 } 145 146 if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 147 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 148 return nullptr; 149 } 150 151 if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 152 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind(); 153 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 154 TSK == TSK_Undeclared) 155 return nullptr; 156 } 157 158 if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { 159 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 160 return nullptr; 161 } 162 if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) { 163 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the 164 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment 165 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition()) 166 return nullptr; 167 } 168 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly. 169 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D)) 170 return nullptr; 171 172 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template 173 // documentation. 174 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) || 175 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) || 176 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D)) 177 return nullptr; 178 179 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments(); 180 181 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything. 182 if (RawComments.empty()) 183 return nullptr; 184 185 // Find declaration location. 186 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple 187 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration 188 // location". 189 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently, 190 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location". 191 SourceLocation DeclLoc; 192 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) || 193 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) || 194 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) || 195 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) 196 DeclLoc = D->getBeginLoc(); 197 else { 198 DeclLoc = D->getLocation(); 199 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) { 200 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) { 201 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being 202 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as 203 // the "declaration location". 204 DeclLoc = D->getBeginLoc(); 205 } else if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) { 206 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of 207 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special 208 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that 209 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can 210 // attach the comment to the tag decl. 211 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) && 212 TD->isCompleteDefinition()) 213 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc); 214 } 215 } 216 } 217 218 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we 219 // can't find the comment. 220 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID()) 221 return nullptr; 222 223 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration. 224 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment; 225 { 226 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking 227 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them 228 // first. 229 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc( 230 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), LangOpts.CommentOpts, false); 231 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr); 232 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1; 233 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc); 234 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) { 235 MaybeBeforeDecl--; 236 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc); 237 } 238 239 if (Found) { 240 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1; 241 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 242 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare)); 243 } else { 244 // Slow path. 245 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(), 246 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare); 247 } 248 } 249 250 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the 251 // file buffer. 252 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc); 253 254 // First check whether we have a trailing comment. 255 if (Comment != RawComments.end() && 256 ((*Comment)->isDocumentation() || LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) 257 && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() && 258 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) || 259 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) { 260 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp 261 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin()); 262 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts 263 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration. 264 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first && 265 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second) 266 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first, 267 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) { 268 return *Comment; 269 } 270 } 271 272 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment. 273 // Let's look at the previous comment. 274 if (Comment == RawComments.begin()) 275 return nullptr; 276 --Comment; 277 278 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment. 279 if (!((*Comment)->isDocumentation() || 280 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) || 281 (*Comment)->isTrailingComment()) 282 return nullptr; 283 284 // Decompose the end of the comment. 285 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp 286 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 287 288 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they 289 // aren't related. 290 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first) 291 return nullptr; 292 293 // Get the corresponding buffer. 294 bool Invalid = false; 295 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first, 296 &Invalid).data(); 297 if (Invalid) 298 return nullptr; 299 300 // Extract text between the comment and declaration. 301 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second, 302 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second); 303 304 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between 305 // comment and declaration. 306 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos) 307 return nullptr; 308 309 return *Comment; 310 } 311 312 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to 313 /// refer to the actual template. 314 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template. 315 static const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) { 316 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 317 // Is this function declaration part of a function template? 318 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 319 return FTD; 320 321 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation. 322 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 323 return D; 324 325 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template? 326 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate()) 327 return FTD; 328 329 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 330 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl = 331 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) 332 return MemberDecl; 333 334 return D; 335 } 336 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 337 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class 338 // template? 339 if (VD->isStaticDataMember()) 340 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) 341 return MemberDecl; 342 343 return D; 344 } 345 if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 346 // Is this class declaration part of a class template? 347 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 348 return CTD; 349 350 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial 351 // specialization? 352 if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) { 353 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 354 return D; 355 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *, 356 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *> 357 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial(); 358 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ? 359 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) : 360 static_cast<const Decl*>( 361 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>()); 362 } 363 364 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 365 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info = 366 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) 367 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom(); 368 369 return D; 370 } 371 if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { 372 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template? 373 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum()) 374 return MemberDecl; 375 376 return D; 377 } 378 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates? 379 return D; 380 } 381 382 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl( 383 const Decl *D, 384 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const { 385 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D); 386 387 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already. 388 { 389 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos = 390 RedeclComments.find(D); 391 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) { 392 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second; 393 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) { 394 if (OriginalDecl) 395 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl(); 396 return Raw.getRaw(); 397 } 398 } 399 } 400 401 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain. 402 const RawComment *RC = nullptr; 403 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr; 404 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 405 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos = 406 RedeclComments.find(I); 407 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) { 408 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second; 409 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) { 410 RC = Raw.getRaw(); 411 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl(); 412 break; 413 } 414 } else { 415 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I); 416 OriginalDeclForRC = I; 417 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw; 418 if (RC) { 419 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32) 420 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530 421 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl); 422 Raw.setRaw(RC); 423 } else 424 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl); 425 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I); 426 RedeclComments[I] = Raw; 427 if (RC) 428 break; 429 } 430 } 431 432 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment. 433 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation() || LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments); 434 435 if (OriginalDecl) 436 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC; 437 438 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain. 439 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw; 440 Raw.setRaw(RC); 441 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl); 442 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC); 443 444 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 445 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I]; 446 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) 447 R = Raw; 448 } 449 450 return RC; 451 } 452 453 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod, 454 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) { 455 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext(); 456 if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) { 457 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface(); 458 if (!ID) 459 return; 460 // Add redeclared method here. 461 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) { 462 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod = 463 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(), 464 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod())) 465 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod); 466 } 467 } 468 } 469 470 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC, 471 const Decl *D) const { 472 auto *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo; 473 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D; 474 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false; 475 ThisDeclInfo->fill(); 476 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl(); 477 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters) 478 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters; 479 comments::FullComment *CFC = 480 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(), 481 ThisDeclInfo); 482 return CFC; 483 } 484 485 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const { 486 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D); 487 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr; 488 } 489 490 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl( 491 const Decl *D, 492 const Preprocessor *PP) const { 493 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 494 return nullptr; 495 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D); 496 497 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl(); 498 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos = 499 ParsedComments.find(Canonical); 500 501 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) { 502 if (Canonical != D) { 503 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second; 504 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D); 505 return CFC; 506 } 507 return Pos->second; 508 } 509 510 const Decl *OriginalDecl; 511 512 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl); 513 if (!RC) { 514 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 515 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden; 516 const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); 517 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor()) 518 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl()) 519 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP)) 520 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 521 if (OMD) 522 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden); 523 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden); 524 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++) 525 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP)) 526 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 527 } 528 else if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 529 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter 530 // does not have one of its own. 531 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType(); 532 if (const auto *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>()) 533 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl()) 534 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP)) 535 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 536 } 537 else if (const auto *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 538 while (IC->getSuperClass()) { 539 IC = IC->getSuperClass(); 540 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP)) 541 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 542 } 543 } 544 else if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) { 545 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface()) 546 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP)) 547 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 548 } 549 else if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { 550 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition())) 551 return nullptr; 552 // Check non-virtual bases. 553 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) { 554 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)) 555 continue; 556 QualType Ty = I.getType(); 557 if (Ty.isNull()) 558 continue; 559 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 560 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition())) 561 continue; 562 563 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP)) 564 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 565 } 566 } 567 // Check virtual bases. 568 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) { 569 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public) 570 continue; 571 QualType Ty = I.getType(); 572 if (Ty.isNull()) 573 continue; 574 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 575 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition())) 576 continue; 577 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP)) 578 return cloneFullComment(FC, D); 579 } 580 } 581 } 582 return nullptr; 583 } 584 585 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we 586 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important 587 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be 588 // different across redeclarations. 589 if (D != OriginalDecl) 590 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP); 591 592 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D); 593 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC; 594 return FC; 595 } 596 597 void 598 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, 599 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) { 600 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth()); 601 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition()); 602 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack()); 603 604 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters(); 605 ID.AddInteger(Params->size()); 606 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(), 607 PEnd = Params->end(); 608 P != PEnd; ++P) { 609 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) { 610 ID.AddInteger(0); 611 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack()); 612 continue; 613 } 614 615 if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) { 616 ID.AddInteger(1); 617 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack()); 618 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr()); 619 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) { 620 ID.AddBoolean(true); 621 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes()); 622 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) { 623 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I); 624 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr()); 625 } 626 } else 627 ID.AddBoolean(false); 628 continue; 629 } 630 631 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P); 632 ID.AddInteger(2); 633 Profile(ID, TTP); 634 } 635 } 636 637 TemplateTemplateParmDecl * 638 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl( 639 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const { 640 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter. 641 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 642 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP); 643 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 644 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical 645 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 646 if (Canonical) 647 return Canonical->getParam(); 648 649 // Build a canonical template parameter list. 650 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters(); 651 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams; 652 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size()); 653 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(), 654 PEnd = Params->end(); 655 P != PEnd; ++P) { 656 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) 657 CanonParams.push_back( 658 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 659 SourceLocation(), 660 SourceLocation(), 661 TTP->getDepth(), 662 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false, 663 TTP->isParameterPack())); 664 else if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) { 665 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType()); 666 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 667 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param; 668 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) { 669 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes; 670 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos; 671 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) { 672 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I))); 673 ExpandedTInfos.push_back( 674 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back())); 675 } 676 677 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 678 SourceLocation(), 679 SourceLocation(), 680 NTTP->getDepth(), 681 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr, 682 T, 683 TInfo, 684 ExpandedTypes, 685 ExpandedTInfos); 686 } else { 687 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 688 SourceLocation(), 689 SourceLocation(), 690 NTTP->getDepth(), 691 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr, 692 T, 693 NTTP->isParameterPack(), 694 TInfo); 695 } 696 CanonParams.push_back(Param); 697 698 } else 699 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl( 700 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P))); 701 } 702 703 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() && 704 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter"); 705 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr; 706 707 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP 708 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 709 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(), 710 TTP->getPosition(), 711 TTP->isParameterPack(), 712 nullptr, 713 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(), 714 SourceLocation(), 715 CanonParams, 716 SourceLocation(), 717 CanonRequiresClause)); 718 719 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 720 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 721 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 722 (void)Canonical; 723 724 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry. 725 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP); 726 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos); 727 return CanonTTP; 728 } 729 730 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) { 731 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr; 732 733 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) { 734 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level 735 case TargetCXXABI::iOS: 736 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64: 737 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS: 738 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: 739 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS: 740 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium: 741 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly: 742 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this); 743 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft: 744 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this); 745 } 746 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!"); 747 } 748 749 static const LangASMap *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T, 750 const LangOptions &LOpts) { 751 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) { 752 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each 753 // language-specific address space. 754 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = { 755 0, // Default 756 1, // opencl_global 757 3, // opencl_local 758 2, // opencl_constant 759 0, // opencl_private 760 4, // opencl_generic 761 5, // cuda_device 762 6, // cuda_constant 763 7 // cuda_shared 764 }; 765 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap; 766 } else { 767 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap(); 768 } 769 } 770 771 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI, 772 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 773 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) { 774 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target: 775 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling(); 776 case LangOptions::ASMM_On: 777 return true; 778 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off: 779 return false; 780 } 781 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything."); 782 } 783 784 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM, 785 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels, 786 Builtin::Context &builtins) 787 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), 788 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), 789 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts), 790 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)), 791 XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles, 792 LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles, 793 LangOpts.XRayAttrListFiles, SM)), 794 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), 795 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), Comments(SM), 796 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), 797 CompCategories(this_()), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) { 798 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this); 799 TraversalScope = {TUDecl}; 800 } 801 802 ASTContext::~ASTContext() { 803 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects. 804 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution? 805 ReleaseDeclContextMaps(); 806 807 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets. 808 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations) 809 (Pair.first)(Pair.second); 810 811 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed 812 // because they can contain DenseMaps. 813 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*, 814 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator 815 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; ) 816 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory. 817 if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second)) 818 R->Destroy(*this); 819 820 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator 821 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) { 822 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory. 823 if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second)) 824 R->Destroy(*this); 825 } 826 827 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(), 828 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end(); 829 A != AEnd; ++A) 830 A->second->~AttrVec(); 831 832 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair : 833 MaterializedTemporaryValues) 834 MTVPair.second->~APValue(); 835 836 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers) 837 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers(); 838 } 839 840 class ASTContext::ParentMap { 841 /// Contains parents of a node. 842 using ParentVector = llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 2>; 843 844 /// Maps from a node to its parents. This is used for nodes that have 845 /// pointer identity only, which are more common and we can save space by 846 /// only storing a unique pointer to them. 847 using ParentMapPointers = llvm::DenseMap< 848 const void *, 849 llvm::PointerUnion4<const Decl *, const Stmt *, 850 ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *, ParentVector *>>; 851 852 /// Parent map for nodes without pointer identity. We store a full 853 /// DynTypedNode for all keys. 854 using ParentMapOtherNodes = llvm::DenseMap< 855 ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 856 llvm::PointerUnion4<const Decl *, const Stmt *, 857 ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *, ParentVector *>>; 858 859 ParentMapPointers PointerParents; 860 ParentMapOtherNodes OtherParents; 861 class ASTVisitor; 862 863 static ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode 864 getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) { 865 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>()) 866 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D); 867 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>()) 868 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S); 869 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 870 } 871 872 template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy> 873 static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node, 874 const MapTy &Map) { 875 auto I = Map.find(Node); 876 if (I == Map.end()) { 877 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>(); 878 } 879 if (const auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ParentVector *>()) { 880 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V); 881 } 882 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second); 883 } 884 885 public: 886 ParentMap(ASTContext &Ctx); 887 ~ParentMap() { 888 for (const auto &Entry : PointerParents) { 889 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) { 890 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 891 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) { 892 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>(); 893 } 894 } 895 for (const auto &Entry : OtherParents) { 896 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) { 897 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 898 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) { 899 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>(); 900 } 901 } 902 } 903 904 DynTypedNodeList getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) { 905 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity()) 906 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), PointerParents); 907 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, OtherParents); 908 } 909 }; 910 911 void ASTContext::setTraversalScope(const std::vector<Decl *> &TopLevelDecls) { 912 TraversalScope = TopLevelDecls; 913 Parents.reset(); 914 } 915 916 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) { 917 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data}); 918 } 919 920 void 921 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) { 922 ExternalSource = std::move(Source); 923 } 924 925 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const { 926 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n"; 927 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n"; 928 929 unsigned counts[] = { 930 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0, 931 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent) 932 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 933 0 // Extra 934 }; 935 936 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) { 937 Type *T = Types[i]; 938 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++; 939 } 940 941 unsigned Idx = 0; 942 unsigned TotalBytes = 0; 943 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) \ 944 if (counts[Idx]) \ 945 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \ 946 << " types, " << sizeof(Name##Type) << " each " \ 947 << "(" << counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type) \ 948 << " bytes)\n"; \ 949 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \ 950 ++Idx; 951 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent) 952 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 953 954 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n"; 955 956 // Implicit special member functions. 957 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/" 958 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors 959 << " implicit default constructors created\n"; 960 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/" 961 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors 962 << " implicit copy constructors created\n"; 963 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 964 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/" 965 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors 966 << " implicit move constructors created\n"; 967 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/" 968 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators 969 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n"; 970 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 971 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/" 972 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators 973 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n"; 974 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/" 975 << NumImplicitDestructors 976 << " implicit destructors created\n"; 977 978 if (ExternalSource) { 979 llvm::errs() << "\n"; 980 ExternalSource->PrintStats(); 981 } 982 983 BumpAlloc.PrintStats(); 984 } 985 986 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M, 987 bool NotifyListeners) { 988 if (NotifyListeners) 989 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener()) 990 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M); 991 992 MergedDefModules[cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl())].push_back(M); 993 } 994 995 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) { 996 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl())); 997 if (It == MergedDefModules.end()) 998 return; 999 1000 auto &Merged = It->second; 1001 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found; 1002 for (Module *&M : Merged) 1003 if (!Found.insert(M).second) 1004 M = nullptr; 1005 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end()); 1006 } 1007 1008 void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) { 1009 if (LazyInitializers.empty()) 1010 return; 1011 1012 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource(); 1013 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source"); 1014 1015 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers); 1016 LazyInitializers.clear(); 1017 1018 for (auto ID : LazyInits) 1019 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID)); 1020 1021 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() && 1022 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits"); 1023 } 1024 1025 void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) { 1026 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another 1027 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify. 1028 if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) { 1029 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule()); 1030 1031 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.) 1032 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end()) 1033 return; 1034 1035 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl. 1036 auto &Imported = *It->second; 1037 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) { 1038 Imported.resolve(*this); 1039 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front(); 1040 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl)) 1041 D = OnlyDecl; 1042 } 1043 } 1044 1045 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M]; 1046 if (!Inits) 1047 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers; 1048 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D); 1049 } 1050 1051 void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) { 1052 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M]; 1053 if (!Inits) 1054 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers; 1055 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(), 1056 IDs.begin(), IDs.end()); 1057 } 1058 1059 ArrayRef<Decl *> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) { 1060 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M); 1061 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end()) 1062 return None; 1063 1064 auto *Inits = It->second; 1065 Inits->resolve(*this); 1066 return Inits->Initializers; 1067 } 1068 1069 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const { 1070 if (!ExternCContext) 1071 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl()); 1072 1073 return ExternCContext; 1074 } 1075 1076 BuiltinTemplateDecl * 1077 ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK, 1078 const IdentifierInfo *II) const { 1079 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK); 1080 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit(); 1081 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate); 1082 1083 return BuiltinTemplate; 1084 } 1085 1086 BuiltinTemplateDecl * 1087 ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const { 1088 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl) 1089 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq, 1090 getMakeIntegerSeqName()); 1091 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl; 1092 } 1093 1094 BuiltinTemplateDecl * 1095 ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const { 1096 if (!TypePackElementDecl) 1097 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element, 1098 getTypePackElementName()); 1099 return TypePackElementDecl; 1100 } 1101 1102 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name, 1103 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const { 1104 SourceLocation Loc; 1105 RecordDecl *NewDecl; 1106 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 1107 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, 1108 Loc, &Idents.get(Name)); 1109 else 1110 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc, 1111 &Idents.get(Name)); 1112 NewDecl->setImplicit(); 1113 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit( 1114 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default)); 1115 return NewDecl; 1116 } 1117 1118 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T, 1119 StringRef Name) const { 1120 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 1121 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create( 1122 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(), 1123 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo); 1124 NewDecl->setImplicit(); 1125 return NewDecl; 1126 } 1127 1128 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const { 1129 if (!Int128Decl) 1130 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t"); 1131 return Int128Decl; 1132 } 1133 1134 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const { 1135 if (!UInt128Decl) 1136 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t"); 1137 return UInt128Decl; 1138 } 1139 1140 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) { 1141 auto *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K); 1142 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0)); 1143 Types.push_back(Ty); 1144 } 1145 1146 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target, 1147 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) { 1148 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) && 1149 "Incorrect target reinitialization"); 1150 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?"); 1151 1152 this->Target = &Target; 1153 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget; 1154 1155 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target)); 1156 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts); 1157 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts); 1158 1159 // C99 6.2.5p19. 1160 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void); 1161 1162 // C99 6.2.5p2. 1163 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool); 1164 // C99 6.2.5p3. 1165 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned) 1166 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S); 1167 else 1168 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U); 1169 // C99 6.2.5p4. 1170 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar); 1171 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short); 1172 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int); 1173 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long); 1174 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong); 1175 1176 // C99 6.2.5p6. 1177 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar); 1178 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort); 1179 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt); 1180 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong); 1181 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong); 1182 1183 // C99 6.2.5p10. 1184 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float); 1185 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double); 1186 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble); 1187 1188 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision 1189 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128); 1190 1191 // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3 1192 InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty, BuiltinType::Float16); 1193 1194 // ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169 Extension 1195 InitBuiltinType(ShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::ShortAccum); 1196 InitBuiltinType(AccumTy, BuiltinType::Accum); 1197 InitBuiltinType(LongAccumTy, BuiltinType::LongAccum); 1198 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::UShortAccum); 1199 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedAccumTy, BuiltinType::UAccum); 1200 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::ULongAccum); 1201 InitBuiltinType(ShortFractTy, BuiltinType::ShortFract); 1202 InitBuiltinType(FractTy, BuiltinType::Fract); 1203 InitBuiltinType(LongFractTy, BuiltinType::LongFract); 1204 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortFractTy, BuiltinType::UShortFract); 1205 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedFractTy, BuiltinType::UFract); 1206 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongFractTy, BuiltinType::ULongFract); 1207 InitBuiltinType(SatShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatShortAccum); 1208 InitBuiltinType(SatAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatAccum); 1209 InitBuiltinType(SatLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatLongAccum); 1210 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum); 1211 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatUAccum); 1212 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatULongAccum); 1213 InitBuiltinType(SatShortFractTy, BuiltinType::SatShortFract); 1214 InitBuiltinType(SatFractTy, BuiltinType::SatFract); 1215 InitBuiltinType(SatLongFractTy, BuiltinType::SatLongFract); 1216 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortFractTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortFract); 1217 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedFractTy, BuiltinType::SatUFract); 1218 InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongFractTy, BuiltinType::SatULongFract); 1219 1220 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers. 1221 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128); 1222 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128); 1223 1224 // C++ 3.9.1p5 1225 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType())) 1226 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S); 1227 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned. 1228 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U); 1229 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar) 1230 WideCharTy = WCharTy; 1231 else { 1232 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar). 1233 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType()); 1234 } 1235 1236 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType()); 1237 1238 // C++20 (proposed) 1239 InitBuiltinType(Char8Ty, BuiltinType::Char8); 1240 1241 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++ 1242 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16); 1243 else // C99 1244 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type()); 1245 1246 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++ 1247 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32); 1248 else // C99 1249 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type()); 1250 1251 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is 1252 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against 1253 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to 1254 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent 1255 // expressions. 1256 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent); 1257 1258 // Placeholder type for functions. 1259 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload); 1260 1261 // Placeholder type for bound members. 1262 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember); 1263 1264 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects. 1265 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject); 1266 1267 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients. 1268 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny); 1269 1270 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts. 1271 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast); 1272 1273 // Placeholder type for builtin functions. 1274 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn); 1275 1276 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections. 1277 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 1278 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection); 1279 1280 // C99 6.2.5p11. 1281 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy); 1282 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy); 1283 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy); 1284 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty); 1285 1286 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'. 1287 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId); 1288 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass); 1289 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel); 1290 1291 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 1292 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 1293 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id); 1294 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 1295 1296 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler); 1297 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent); 1298 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent); 1299 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue); 1300 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID); 1301 1302 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 1303 InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id); 1304 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 1305 } 1306 1307 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no 1308 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ? 1309 SignedCharTy : BoolTy); 1310 1311 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType(); 1312 1313 ObjCSuperType = QualType(); 1314 1315 // void * type 1316 if (LangOpts.OpenCLVersion >= 200) { 1317 auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers(); 1318 Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic); 1319 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType( 1320 getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q))); 1321 } else { 1322 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy); 1323 } 1324 1325 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7) 1326 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr); 1327 1328 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16 1329 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half); 1330 1331 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list. 1332 VaListTagDecl = nullptr; 1333 } 1334 1335 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const { 1336 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics(); 1337 } 1338 1339 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) { 1340 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D]; 1341 if (!Result) { 1342 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec)); 1343 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec; 1344 } 1345 1346 return *Result; 1347 } 1348 1349 /// Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration. 1350 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) { 1351 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D); 1352 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) { 1353 Pos->second->~AttrVec(); 1354 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos); 1355 } 1356 } 1357 1358 // FIXME: Remove ? 1359 MemberSpecializationInfo * 1360 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) { 1361 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1362 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var) 1363 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>(); 1364 } 1365 1366 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo 1367 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) { 1368 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos = 1369 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var); 1370 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end()) 1371 return {}; 1372 1373 return Pos->second; 1374 } 1375 1376 void 1377 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl, 1378 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, 1379 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) { 1380 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1381 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member"); 1382 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo( 1383 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation)); 1384 } 1385 1386 void 1387 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst, 1388 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) { 1389 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] && 1390 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from"); 1391 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI; 1392 } 1393 1394 FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern( 1395 const FunctionDecl *FD){ 1396 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0"); 1397 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos 1398 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD); 1399 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end()) 1400 return nullptr; 1401 1402 return Pos->second; 1403 } 1404 1405 void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD, 1406 FunctionDecl *Pattern) { 1407 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0"); 1408 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0"); 1409 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern; 1410 } 1411 1412 NamedDecl * 1413 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) { 1414 auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD); 1415 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end()) 1416 return nullptr; 1417 1418 return Pos->second; 1419 } 1420 1421 void 1422 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) { 1423 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) || 1424 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) || 1425 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) && 1426 "pattern decl is not a using decl"); 1427 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) || 1428 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) || 1429 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) && 1430 "instantiation did not produce a using decl"); 1431 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists"); 1432 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern; 1433 } 1434 1435 UsingShadowDecl * 1436 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) { 1437 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos 1438 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst); 1439 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end()) 1440 return nullptr; 1441 1442 return Pos->second; 1443 } 1444 1445 void 1446 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst, 1447 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) { 1448 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists"); 1449 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern; 1450 } 1451 1452 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) { 1453 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos 1454 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field); 1455 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end()) 1456 return nullptr; 1457 1458 return Pos->second; 1459 } 1460 1461 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst, 1462 FieldDecl *Tmpl) { 1463 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed"); 1464 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed"); 1465 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] && 1466 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from"); 1467 1468 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl; 1469 } 1470 1471 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator 1472 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1473 return overridden_methods(Method).begin(); 1474 } 1475 1476 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator 1477 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1478 return overridden_methods(Method).end(); 1479 } 1480 1481 unsigned 1482 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1483 auto Range = overridden_methods(Method); 1484 return Range.end() - Range.begin(); 1485 } 1486 1487 ASTContext::overridden_method_range 1488 ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const { 1489 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos = 1490 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl()); 1491 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end()) 1492 return overridden_method_range(nullptr, nullptr); 1493 return overridden_method_range(Pos->second.begin(), Pos->second.end()); 1494 } 1495 1496 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method, 1497 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) { 1498 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl()); 1499 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden); 1500 } 1501 1502 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods( 1503 const NamedDecl *D, 1504 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const { 1505 assert(D); 1506 1507 if (const auto *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 1508 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod), 1509 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod)); 1510 return; 1511 } 1512 1513 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); 1514 if (!Method) 1515 return; 1516 1517 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls; 1518 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls); 1519 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end()); 1520 } 1521 1522 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) { 1523 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain"); 1524 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration"); 1525 if (!FirstLocalImport) { 1526 FirstLocalImport = Import; 1527 LastLocalImport = Import; 1528 return; 1529 } 1530 1531 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import; 1532 LastLocalImport = Import; 1533 } 1534 1535 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1536 // Type Sizing and Analysis 1537 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1538 1539 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified 1540 /// scalar floating point type. 1541 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const { 1542 const auto *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1543 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!"); 1544 switch (BT->getKind()) { 1545 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!"); 1546 case BuiltinType::Float16: 1547 case BuiltinType::Half: 1548 return Target->getHalfFormat(); 1549 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat(); 1550 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat(); 1551 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat(); 1552 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format(); 1553 } 1554 } 1555 1556 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const { 1557 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth(); 1558 1559 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false; 1560 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) { 1561 Align = AlignFromAttr; 1562 1563 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment 1564 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases 1565 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified. 1566 // 1567 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can 1568 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it. 1569 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) { 1570 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() || 1571 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 1572 } else { 1573 UseAlignAttrOnly = true; 1574 } 1575 } 1576 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) 1577 UseAlignAttrOnly = 1578 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() || 1579 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 1580 1581 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything 1582 // else about the declaration and its type. 1583 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) { 1584 // do nothing 1585 } else if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) { 1586 QualType T = VD->getType(); 1587 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 1588 if (ForAlignof) 1589 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 1590 else 1591 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType()); 1592 } 1593 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T); 1594 if (T->isFunctionType()) 1595 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align; 1596 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) { 1597 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the 1598 // large-array alignment on the target. 1599 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) { 1600 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth(); 1601 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) { 1602 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType)) 1603 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign()); 1604 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) && 1605 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType))) 1606 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign()); 1607 } 1608 } 1609 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr())); 1610 if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 1611 Align = Target->getCharWidth(); 1612 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1613 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof) 1614 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign()); 1615 } 1616 } 1617 1618 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if 1619 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a 1620 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate 1621 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then 1622 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type. 1623 if (const auto *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 1624 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent(); 1625 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid. 1626 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) { 1627 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent); 1628 1629 // Start with the record's overall alignment. 1630 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 1631 1632 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record. 1633 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex()); 1634 if (Offset > 0) { 1635 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2, 1636 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's. 1637 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1); 1638 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign) 1639 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset); 1640 } 1641 1642 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign); 1643 } 1644 } 1645 } 1646 1647 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align); 1648 } 1649 1650 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in 1651 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is 1652 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type 1653 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator. 1654 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1655 ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const { 1656 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T); 1657 1658 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding 1659 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible 1660 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results. 1661 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1662 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) { 1663 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl()); 1664 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize(); 1665 } 1666 } 1667 1668 return sizeAndAlign; 1669 } 1670 1671 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits 1672 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays. 1673 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1674 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context, 1675 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) { 1676 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo = 1677 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType()); 1678 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 1679 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <= 1680 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) && 1681 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation"); 1682 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size; 1683 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity(); 1684 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() || 1685 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64) 1686 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align); 1687 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width), 1688 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)); 1689 } 1690 1691 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1692 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const { 1693 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T)) 1694 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT); 1695 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T); 1696 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width), 1697 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align)); 1698 } 1699 1700 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> 1701 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const { 1702 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr()); 1703 } 1704 1705 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const { 1706 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired; 1707 } 1708 1709 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const { 1710 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr()); 1711 } 1712 1713 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const { 1714 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else. 1715 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) 1716 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment()) 1717 return Align; 1718 1719 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done. 1720 T = getBaseElementType(T); 1721 if (!T->isIncompleteType()) 1722 return getTypeAlign(T); 1723 1724 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef 1725 // type with an alignment attribute. 1726 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) 1727 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment()) 1728 return Align; 1729 1730 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute. 1731 if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>()) 1732 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment(); 1733 1734 return 0; 1735 } 1736 1737 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const { 1738 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T); 1739 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end()) 1740 return I->second; 1741 1742 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup. 1743 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T); 1744 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI; 1745 return TI; 1746 } 1747 1748 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This 1749 /// method does not work on incomplete types. 1750 /// 1751 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and 1752 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this 1753 /// should take a QualType, &c. 1754 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const { 1755 uint64_t Width = 0; 1756 unsigned Align = 8; 1757 bool AlignIsRequired = false; 1758 unsigned AS = 0; 1759 switch (T->getTypeClass()) { 1760 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 1761 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 1762 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 1763 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 1764 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \ 1765 case Type::Class: \ 1766 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \ 1767 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr()); 1768 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 1769 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types"); 1770 1771 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 1772 case Type::FunctionProto: 1773 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits 1774 Width = 0; 1775 Align = 32; 1776 break; 1777 1778 case Type::IncompleteArray: 1779 case Type::VariableArray: 1780 Width = 0; 1781 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType()); 1782 break; 1783 1784 case Type::ConstantArray: { 1785 const auto *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T); 1786 1787 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType()); 1788 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 1789 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) && 1790 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation"); 1791 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size; 1792 Align = EltInfo.Align; 1793 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() || 1794 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64) 1795 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align); 1796 break; 1797 } 1798 case Type::ExtVector: 1799 case Type::Vector: { 1800 const auto *VT = cast<VectorType>(T); 1801 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType()); 1802 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements(); 1803 Align = Width; 1804 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2. 1805 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors. 1806 if (Align & (Align-1)) { 1807 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align); 1808 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align); 1809 } 1810 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max. 1811 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign(); 1812 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align) 1813 Align = TargetVectorAlign; 1814 break; 1815 } 1816 1817 case Type::Builtin: 1818 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) { 1819 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!"); 1820 case BuiltinType::Void: 1821 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits. 1822 Width = 0; 1823 Align = 8; 1824 break; 1825 case BuiltinType::Bool: 1826 Width = Target->getBoolWidth(); 1827 Align = Target->getBoolAlign(); 1828 break; 1829 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 1830 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 1831 case BuiltinType::UChar: 1832 case BuiltinType::SChar: 1833 case BuiltinType::Char8: 1834 Width = Target->getCharWidth(); 1835 Align = Target->getCharAlign(); 1836 break; 1837 case BuiltinType::WChar_S: 1838 case BuiltinType::WChar_U: 1839 Width = Target->getWCharWidth(); 1840 Align = Target->getWCharAlign(); 1841 break; 1842 case BuiltinType::Char16: 1843 Width = Target->getChar16Width(); 1844 Align = Target->getChar16Align(); 1845 break; 1846 case BuiltinType::Char32: 1847 Width = Target->getChar32Width(); 1848 Align = Target->getChar32Align(); 1849 break; 1850 case BuiltinType::UShort: 1851 case BuiltinType::Short: 1852 Width = Target->getShortWidth(); 1853 Align = Target->getShortAlign(); 1854 break; 1855 case BuiltinType::UInt: 1856 case BuiltinType::Int: 1857 Width = Target->getIntWidth(); 1858 Align = Target->getIntAlign(); 1859 break; 1860 case BuiltinType::ULong: 1861 case BuiltinType::Long: 1862 Width = Target->getLongWidth(); 1863 Align = Target->getLongAlign(); 1864 break; 1865 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 1866 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 1867 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth(); 1868 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign(); 1869 break; 1870 case BuiltinType::Int128: 1871 case BuiltinType::UInt128: 1872 Width = 128; 1873 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets. 1874 break; 1875 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 1876 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 1877 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 1878 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 1879 Width = Target->getShortAccumWidth(); 1880 Align = Target->getShortAccumAlign(); 1881 break; 1882 case BuiltinType::Accum: 1883 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 1884 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 1885 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 1886 Width = Target->getAccumWidth(); 1887 Align = Target->getAccumAlign(); 1888 break; 1889 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 1890 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 1891 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 1892 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 1893 Width = Target->getLongAccumWidth(); 1894 Align = Target->getLongAccumAlign(); 1895 break; 1896 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 1897 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 1898 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 1899 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 1900 Width = Target->getShortFractWidth(); 1901 Align = Target->getShortFractAlign(); 1902 break; 1903 case BuiltinType::Fract: 1904 case BuiltinType::UFract: 1905 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 1906 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 1907 Width = Target->getFractWidth(); 1908 Align = Target->getFractAlign(); 1909 break; 1910 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 1911 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 1912 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 1913 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 1914 Width = Target->getLongFractWidth(); 1915 Align = Target->getLongFractAlign(); 1916 break; 1917 case BuiltinType::Float16: 1918 case BuiltinType::Half: 1919 Width = Target->getHalfWidth(); 1920 Align = Target->getHalfAlign(); 1921 break; 1922 case BuiltinType::Float: 1923 Width = Target->getFloatWidth(); 1924 Align = Target->getFloatAlign(); 1925 break; 1926 case BuiltinType::Double: 1927 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth(); 1928 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign(); 1929 break; 1930 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 1931 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth(); 1932 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign(); 1933 break; 1934 case BuiltinType::Float128: 1935 Width = Target->getFloat128Width(); 1936 Align = Target->getFloat128Align(); 1937 break; 1938 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: 1939 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t) 1940 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*) 1941 break; 1942 case BuiltinType::ObjCId: 1943 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass: 1944 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel: 1945 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); 1946 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); 1947 break; 1948 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: 1949 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: 1950 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: 1951 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: 1952 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: 1953 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 1954 case BuiltinType::Id: 1955 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 1956 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 1957 case BuiltinType::Id: 1958 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 1959 AS = getTargetAddressSpace( 1960 Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T))); 1961 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1962 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1963 break; 1964 } 1965 break; 1966 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 1967 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); 1968 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); 1969 break; 1970 case Type::BlockPointer: 1971 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1972 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1973 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1974 break; 1975 case Type::LValueReference: 1976 case Type::RValueReference: 1977 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go 1978 // the pointer route. 1979 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1980 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1981 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1982 break; 1983 case Type::Pointer: 1984 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType()); 1985 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS); 1986 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS); 1987 break; 1988 case Type::MemberPointer: { 1989 const auto *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T); 1990 CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT); 1991 Width = MPI.Width; 1992 Align = MPI.Align; 1993 break; 1994 } 1995 case Type::Complex: { 1996 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the 1997 // size. 1998 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType()); 1999 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2; 2000 Align = EltInfo.Align; 2001 break; 2002 } 2003 case Type::ObjCObject: 2004 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr()); 2005 case Type::Adjusted: 2006 case Type::Decayed: 2007 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr()); 2008 case Type::ObjCInterface: { 2009 const auto *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T); 2010 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl()); 2011 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize()); 2012 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 2013 break; 2014 } 2015 case Type::Record: 2016 case Type::Enum: { 2017 const auto *TT = cast<TagType>(T); 2018 2019 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) { 2020 Width = 8; 2021 Align = 8; 2022 break; 2023 } 2024 2025 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) { 2026 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl(); 2027 TypeInfo Info = 2028 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); 2029 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) { 2030 Info.Align = AttrAlign; 2031 Info.AlignIsRequired = true; 2032 } 2033 return Info; 2034 } 2035 2036 const auto *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT); 2037 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2038 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2039 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize()); 2040 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment()); 2041 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>(); 2042 break; 2043 } 2044 2045 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 2046 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)-> 2047 getReplacementType().getTypePtr()); 2048 2049 case Type::Auto: 2050 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: { 2051 const auto *A = cast<DeducedType>(T); 2052 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() && 2053 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type"); 2054 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr()); 2055 } 2056 2057 case Type::Paren: 2058 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr()); 2059 2060 case Type::ObjCTypeParam: 2061 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr()); 2062 2063 case Type::Typedef: { 2064 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl(); 2065 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr()); 2066 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed 2067 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that 2068 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation. 2069 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) { 2070 Align = AttrAlign; 2071 AlignIsRequired = true; 2072 } else { 2073 Align = Info.Align; 2074 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired; 2075 } 2076 Width = Info.Width; 2077 break; 2078 } 2079 2080 case Type::Elaborated: 2081 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr()); 2082 2083 case Type::Attributed: 2084 return getTypeInfo( 2085 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr()); 2086 2087 case Type::Atomic: { 2088 // Start with the base type information. 2089 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType()); 2090 Width = Info.Width; 2091 Align = Info.Align; 2092 2093 if (!Width) { 2094 // An otherwise zero-sized type should still generate an 2095 // atomic operation. 2096 Width = Target->getCharWidth(); 2097 assert(Align); 2098 } else if (Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) { 2099 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max 2100 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more 2101 // favorable to atomic operations: 2102 2103 // Round the size up to a power of 2. 2104 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width)) 2105 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width); 2106 2107 // Set the alignment equal to the size. 2108 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width); 2109 } 2110 } 2111 break; 2112 2113 case Type::Pipe: 2114 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global)); 2115 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global)); 2116 break; 2117 } 2118 2119 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2"); 2120 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired); 2121 } 2122 2123 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlign(const Type *T) const { 2124 UnadjustedAlignMap::iterator I = MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.find(T); 2125 if (I != MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.end()) 2126 return I->second; 2127 2128 unsigned UnadjustedAlign; 2129 if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2130 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2131 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2132 UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment()); 2133 } else if (const auto *ObjCI = T->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>()) { 2134 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl()); 2135 UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment()); 2136 } else { 2137 UnadjustedAlign = getTypeAlign(T); 2138 } 2139 2140 MemoizedUnadjustedAlign[T] = UnadjustedAlign; 2141 return UnadjustedAlign; 2142 } 2143 2144 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const { 2145 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign(); 2146 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32. 2147 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 || 2148 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) && 2149 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" && 2150 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) 2151 SimdAlign = 256; 2152 return SimdAlign; 2153 } 2154 2155 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters. 2156 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const { 2157 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth()); 2158 } 2159 2160 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters. 2161 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const { 2162 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth(); 2163 } 2164 2165 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters. 2166 /// This method does not work on incomplete types. 2167 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const { 2168 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first; 2169 } 2170 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const { 2171 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first; 2172 } 2173 2174 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in 2175 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types. 2176 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const { 2177 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T)); 2178 } 2179 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const { 2180 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T)); 2181 } 2182 2183 /// getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a 2184 /// type, in characters, before alignment adustments. This method does 2185 /// not work on incomplete types. 2186 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(QualType T) const { 2187 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T)); 2188 } 2189 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(const Type *T) const { 2190 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T)); 2191 } 2192 2193 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified 2194 /// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI 2195 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign 2196 /// a data type. 2197 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const { 2198 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T); 2199 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align; 2200 2201 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2202 2203 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer. 2204 if (T->isMemberPointerType()) 2205 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr()); 2206 2207 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment()) 2208 return ABIAlign; 2209 2210 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible. 2211 if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>()) 2212 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr(); 2213 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 2214 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr(); 2215 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) || 2216 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) || 2217 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong)) 2218 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a 2219 // typedef declaration. 2220 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired) 2221 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T)); 2222 2223 return ABIAlign; 2224 } 2225 2226 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment 2227 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment 2228 /// value is specified. 2229 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const { 2230 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(); 2231 } 2232 2233 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given 2234 /// to a global variable of the specified type. 2235 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const { 2236 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign()); 2237 } 2238 2239 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that 2240 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type. 2241 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const { 2242 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T)); 2243 } 2244 2245 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const { 2246 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero(); 2247 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2248 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) { 2249 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base); 2250 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base); 2251 } 2252 return Offset; 2253 } 2254 2255 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars - 2256 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in 2257 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for 2258 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class 2259 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known. 2260 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI, 2261 bool leafClass, 2262 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const { 2263 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass()) 2264 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars); 2265 if (!leafClass) { 2266 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars()) 2267 Ivars.push_back(I); 2268 } else { 2269 auto *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI); 2270 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv; 2271 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar()) 2272 Ivars.push_back(Iv); 2273 } 2274 } 2275 2276 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and 2277 /// those inherited by it. 2278 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl, 2279 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) { 2280 if (const auto *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) { 2281 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of 2282 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories. 2283 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) { 2284 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 2285 } 2286 2287 // Categories of this Interface. 2288 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories()) 2289 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols); 2290 2291 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass()) 2292 while (SD) { 2293 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols); 2294 SD = SD->getSuperClass(); 2295 } 2296 } else if (const auto *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) { 2297 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) { 2298 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 2299 } 2300 } else if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) { 2301 // Insert the protocol. 2302 if (!Protocols.insert( 2303 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second) 2304 return; 2305 2306 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) 2307 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols); 2308 } 2309 } 2310 2311 static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context, 2312 const RecordDecl *RD) { 2313 assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type"); 2314 CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl()); 2315 2316 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) { 2317 if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType())) 2318 return false; 2319 CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()); 2320 if (FieldSize != UnionSize) 2321 return false; 2322 } 2323 return !RD->field_empty(); 2324 } 2325 2326 static bool isStructEmpty(QualType Ty) { 2327 const RecordDecl *RD = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 2328 2329 if (!RD->field_empty()) 2330 return false; 2331 2332 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 2333 return ClassDecl->isEmpty(); 2334 2335 return true; 2336 } 2337 2338 static llvm::Optional<int64_t> 2339 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context, 2340 const RecordDecl *RD) { 2341 assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type"); 2342 const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2343 2344 int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0; 2345 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2346 if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass()) 2347 return llvm::None; 2348 2349 SmallVector<std::pair<QualType, int64_t>, 4> Bases; 2350 for (const auto Base : ClassDecl->bases()) { 2351 // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially 2352 // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error. 2353 if (!isStructEmpty(Base.getType())) { 2354 llvm::Optional<int64_t> Size = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations( 2355 Context, Base.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2356 if (!Size) 2357 return llvm::None; 2358 Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType(), Size.getValue()); 2359 } 2360 } 2361 2362 llvm::sort(Bases, [&](const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &L, 2363 const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &R) { 2364 return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) < 2365 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()); 2366 }); 2367 2368 for (const auto Base : Bases) { 2369 int64_t BaseOffset = Context.toBits( 2370 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl())); 2371 int64_t BaseSize = Base.second; 2372 if (BaseOffset != CurOffsetInBits) 2373 return llvm::None; 2374 CurOffsetInBits = BaseOffset + BaseSize; 2375 } 2376 } 2377 2378 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) { 2379 if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() && 2380 !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType())) 2381 return llvm::None; 2382 2383 int64_t FieldSizeInBits = 2384 Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType())); 2385 if (Field->isBitField()) { 2386 int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context); 2387 2388 if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits) 2389 return llvm::None; 2390 FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize; 2391 } 2392 2393 int64_t FieldOffsetInBits = Context.getFieldOffset(Field); 2394 2395 if (FieldOffsetInBits != CurOffsetInBits) 2396 return llvm::None; 2397 2398 CurOffsetInBits = FieldSizeInBits + FieldOffsetInBits; 2399 } 2400 2401 return CurOffsetInBits; 2402 } 2403 2404 bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty) const { 2405 // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]: 2406 // The predicate condition for a template specialization 2407 // has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be 2408 // satisfied if and only if: 2409 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and 2410 // (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same 2411 // object representation, where two objects 2412 // of array or non-union class type are considered to have the same value 2413 // if their respective sequences of 2414 // direct subobjects have the same values, and two objects of union type 2415 // are considered to have the same 2416 // value if they have the same active member and the corresponding members 2417 // have the same value. 2418 // The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is 2419 // implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding 2420 // bits, the condition does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true 2421 // for unsigned integral types. -- end note ] 2422 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check"); 2423 2424 // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique. 2425 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 2426 return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty)); 2427 2428 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable... 2429 if (!Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this)) 2430 return false; 2431 2432 // All integrals and enums are unique. 2433 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 2434 return true; 2435 2436 // All other pointers are unique. 2437 if (Ty->isPointerType()) 2438 return true; 2439 2440 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 2441 const auto *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2442 return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding; 2443 } 2444 2445 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 2446 const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 2447 2448 if (Record->isInvalidDecl()) 2449 return false; 2450 2451 if (Record->isUnion()) 2452 return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record); 2453 2454 Optional<int64_t> StructSize = 2455 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record); 2456 2457 return StructSize && 2458 StructSize.getValue() == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty)); 2459 } 2460 2461 // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith): 2462 // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo) 2463 // _Complex int and friends 2464 // _Atomic T 2465 // Obj-C block pointers 2466 // Obj-C object pointers 2467 // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t, 2468 // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t) 2469 // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it 2470 // makes sense for those to return false here. 2471 2472 return false; 2473 } 2474 2475 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const { 2476 unsigned count = 0; 2477 // Count ivars declared in class extension. 2478 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions()) 2479 count += Ext->ivar_size(); 2480 2481 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This 2482 // includes synthesized ivars. 2483 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation()) 2484 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size(); 2485 2486 return count; 2487 } 2488 2489 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) { 2490 if (!E) 2491 return false; 2492 2493 // nullptr_t is always treated as null. 2494 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true; 2495 2496 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() && 2497 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this, 2498 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2499 return true; 2500 2501 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'. 2502 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true; 2503 2504 return false; 2505 } 2506 2507 /// Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none 2508 /// exists. 2509 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) { 2510 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator 2511 I = ObjCImpls.find(D); 2512 if (I != ObjCImpls.end()) 2513 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second); 2514 return nullptr; 2515 } 2516 2517 /// Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none 2518 /// exists. 2519 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) { 2520 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator 2521 I = ObjCImpls.find(D); 2522 if (I != ObjCImpls.end()) 2523 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second); 2524 return nullptr; 2525 } 2526 2527 /// Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl. 2528 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD, 2529 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) { 2530 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params"); 2531 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD; 2532 } 2533 2534 /// Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl. 2535 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD, 2536 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) { 2537 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params"); 2538 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD; 2539 } 2540 2541 const ObjCMethodDecl * 2542 ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const { 2543 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD); 2544 } 2545 2546 void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD, 2547 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) { 2548 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration"); 2549 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl; 2550 } 2551 2552 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface( 2553 const NamedDecl *ND) const { 2554 if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2555 return ID; 2556 if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2557 return CD->getClassInterface(); 2558 if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext())) 2559 return IMD->getClassInterface(); 2560 2561 return nullptr; 2562 } 2563 2564 /// Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if 2565 /// none exists. 2566 ASTContext::BlockVarCopyInit 2567 ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl*VD) const { 2568 assert(VD && "Passed null params"); 2569 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && 2570 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var"); 2571 auto I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD); 2572 if (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) 2573 return I->second; 2574 return {nullptr, false}; 2575 } 2576 2577 /// Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl. 2578 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl*VD, Expr *CopyExpr, 2579 bool CanThrow) { 2580 assert(VD && CopyExpr && "Passed null params"); 2581 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && 2582 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var"); 2583 BlockVarCopyInits[VD].setExprAndFlag(CopyExpr, CanThrow); 2584 } 2585 2586 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T, 2587 unsigned DataSize) const { 2588 if (!DataSize) 2589 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T); 2590 else 2591 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) && 2592 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!"); 2593 2594 auto *TInfo = 2595 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8); 2596 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T); 2597 return TInfo; 2598 } 2599 2600 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T, 2601 SourceLocation L) const { 2602 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T); 2603 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L); 2604 return DI; 2605 } 2606 2607 const ASTRecordLayout & 2608 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const { 2609 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr); 2610 } 2611 2612 const ASTRecordLayout & 2613 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout( 2614 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const { 2615 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D); 2616 } 2617 2618 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2619 // Type creation/memoization methods 2620 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 2621 2622 QualType 2623 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const { 2624 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers(); 2625 quals.removeFastQualifiers(); 2626 2627 // Check if we've already instantiated this type. 2628 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2629 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals); 2630 void *insertPos = nullptr; 2631 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) { 2632 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals); 2633 return QualType(eq, fastQuals); 2634 } 2635 2636 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type. 2637 QualType canon; 2638 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 2639 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split(); 2640 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals); 2641 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals); 2642 2643 // Re-find the insert position. 2644 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 2645 } 2646 2647 auto *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals); 2648 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos); 2649 return QualType(eq, fastQuals); 2650 } 2651 2652 QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, 2653 LangAS AddressSpace) const { 2654 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T); 2655 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace) 2656 return T; 2657 2658 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together 2659 // into one ExtQuals node. 2660 QualifierCollector Quals; 2661 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T); 2662 2663 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get 2664 // another one. 2665 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() && 2666 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!"); 2667 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace); 2668 2669 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals); 2670 } 2671 2672 QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const { 2673 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together 2674 // into one ExtQuals node. 2675 QualifierCollector Quals; 2676 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T); 2677 2678 // If the qualifier doesn't have an address space just return it. 2679 if (!Quals.hasAddressSpace()) 2680 return T; 2681 2682 Quals.removeAddressSpace(); 2683 2684 // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any 2685 // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts) 2686 // or required. 2687 if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers()) 2688 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals); 2689 else 2690 return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers()); 2691 } 2692 2693 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T, 2694 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const { 2695 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T); 2696 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr) 2697 return T; 2698 2699 if (const auto *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2700 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType(); 2701 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) { 2702 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr); 2703 return getPointerType(ResultType); 2704 } 2705 } 2706 2707 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together 2708 // into one ExtQuals node. 2709 QualifierCollector Quals; 2710 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T); 2711 2712 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get 2713 // another one. 2714 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() && 2715 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!"); 2716 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr); 2717 2718 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals); 2719 } 2720 2721 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T, 2722 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) { 2723 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info) 2724 return T; 2725 2726 QualType Result; 2727 if (const auto *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) { 2728 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info); 2729 } else { 2730 const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T); 2731 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 2732 EPI.ExtInfo = Info; 2733 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 2734 } 2735 2736 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr()); 2737 } 2738 2739 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD, 2740 QualType ResultType) { 2741 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl(); 2742 while (true) { 2743 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2744 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 2745 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 2746 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl()) 2747 FD = Next; 2748 else 2749 break; 2750 } 2751 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) 2752 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType); 2753 } 2754 2755 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the 2756 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a 2757 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted 2758 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not. 2759 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec( 2760 QualType Orig, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) { 2761 // Might have some parens. 2762 if (const auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig)) 2763 return getParenType( 2764 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(PT->getInnerType(), ESI)); 2765 2766 // Might have a calling-convention attribute. 2767 if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig)) 2768 return getAttributedType( 2769 AT->getAttrKind(), 2770 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getModifiedType(), ESI), 2771 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getEquivalentType(), ESI)); 2772 2773 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception 2774 // specification. 2775 const auto *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig); 2776 return getFunctionType( 2777 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(), 2778 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI)); 2779 } 2780 2781 bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T, 2782 QualType U) { 2783 return hasSameType(T, U) || 2784 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 2785 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(T, EST_None), 2786 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(U, EST_None))); 2787 } 2788 2789 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec( 2790 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, 2791 bool AsWritten) { 2792 // Update the type. 2793 QualType Updated = 2794 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(FD->getType(), ESI); 2795 FD->setType(Updated); 2796 2797 if (!AsWritten) 2798 return; 2799 2800 // Update the type in the type source information too. 2801 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 2802 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update 2803 // the type-as-written too. 2804 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType()) 2805 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(TSInfo->getType(), ESI); 2806 2807 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions, 2808 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch 2809 // up the TypeSourceInfo; 2810 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) == 2811 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) && 2812 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification"); 2813 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated); 2814 } 2815 } 2816 2817 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex 2818 /// number with the specified element type. 2819 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const { 2820 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2821 // structure. 2822 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2823 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T); 2824 2825 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2826 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2827 return QualType(CT, 0); 2828 2829 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2830 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2831 QualType Canonical; 2832 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2833 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2834 2835 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2836 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2837 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2838 } 2839 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical); 2840 Types.push_back(New); 2841 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2842 return QualType(New, 0); 2843 } 2844 2845 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to 2846 /// the specified type. 2847 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const { 2848 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2849 // structure. 2850 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2851 PointerType::Profile(ID, T); 2852 2853 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2854 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2855 return QualType(PT, 0); 2856 2857 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 2858 // so fill in the canonical type field. 2859 QualType Canonical; 2860 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2861 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2862 2863 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2864 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2865 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2866 } 2867 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical); 2868 Types.push_back(New); 2869 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2870 return QualType(New, 0); 2871 } 2872 2873 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const { 2874 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2875 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New); 2876 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2877 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2878 if (AT) 2879 return QualType(AT, 0); 2880 2881 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New); 2882 2883 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2884 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2885 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 2886 2887 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 2888 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical); 2889 Types.push_back(AT); 2890 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 2891 return QualType(AT, 0); 2892 } 2893 2894 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const { 2895 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay"); 2896 2897 QualType Decayed; 2898 2899 // C99 6.7.5.3p7: 2900 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be 2901 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type 2902 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of 2903 // the array type derivation. 2904 if (T->isArrayType()) 2905 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T); 2906 2907 // C99 6.7.5.3p8: 2908 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type" 2909 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as 2910 // in 6.3.2.1. 2911 if (T->isFunctionType()) 2912 Decayed = getPointerType(T); 2913 2914 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2915 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed); 2916 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2917 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2918 if (AT) 2919 return QualType(AT, 0); 2920 2921 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed); 2922 2923 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2924 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2925 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 2926 2927 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical); 2928 Types.push_back(AT); 2929 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 2930 return QualType(AT, 0); 2931 } 2932 2933 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for 2934 /// a pointer to the specified block. 2935 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const { 2936 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only"); 2937 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular 2938 // structure. 2939 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2940 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T); 2941 2942 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2943 if (BlockPointerType *PT = 2944 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2945 return QualType(PT, 0); 2946 2947 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical 2948 // type either so fill in the canonical type field. 2949 QualType Canonical; 2950 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 2951 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T)); 2952 2953 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2954 BlockPointerType *NewIP = 2955 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2956 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2957 } 2958 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical); 2959 Types.push_back(New); 2960 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 2961 return QualType(New, 0); 2962 } 2963 2964 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an 2965 /// lvalue reference to the specified type. 2966 QualType 2967 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const { 2968 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy && 2969 "Unresolved overloaded function type"); 2970 2971 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 2972 // structure. 2973 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2974 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue); 2975 2976 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 2977 if (LValueReferenceType *RT = 2978 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 2979 return QualType(RT, 0); 2980 2981 const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 2982 2983 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 2984 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 2985 QualType Canonical; 2986 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) { 2987 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T); 2988 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType)); 2989 2990 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 2991 LValueReferenceType *NewIP = 2992 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 2993 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 2994 } 2995 2996 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical, 2997 SpelledAsLValue); 2998 Types.push_back(New); 2999 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3000 3001 return QualType(New, 0); 3002 } 3003 3004 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an 3005 /// rvalue reference to the specified type. 3006 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const { 3007 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 3008 // structure. 3009 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3010 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false); 3011 3012 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3013 if (RValueReferenceType *RT = 3014 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3015 return QualType(RT, 0); 3016 3017 const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 3018 3019 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 3020 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 3021 QualType Canonical; 3022 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) { 3023 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T); 3024 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType)); 3025 3026 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3027 RValueReferenceType *NewIP = 3028 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3029 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3030 } 3031 3032 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical); 3033 Types.push_back(New); 3034 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3035 return QualType(New, 0); 3036 } 3037 3038 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a 3039 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class. 3040 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const { 3041 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 3042 // structure. 3043 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3044 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls); 3045 3046 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3047 if (MemberPointerType *PT = 3048 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3049 return QualType(PT, 0); 3050 3051 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical 3052 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field. 3053 QualType Canonical; 3054 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 3055 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls)); 3056 3057 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3058 MemberPointerType *NewIP = 3059 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3060 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3061 } 3062 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical); 3063 Types.push_back(New); 3064 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3065 return QualType(New, 0); 3066 } 3067 3068 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an 3069 /// array of the specified element type. 3070 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy, 3071 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn, 3072 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 3073 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const { 3074 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() || 3075 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) && 3076 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!"); 3077 3078 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for 3079 // the target. 3080 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn); 3081 ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth()); 3082 3083 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3084 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 3085 3086 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3087 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP = 3088 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3089 return QualType(ATP, 0); 3090 3091 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't 3092 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field. 3093 QualType Canon; 3094 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 3095 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split(); 3096 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize, 3097 ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 3098 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals); 3099 3100 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3101 ConstantArrayType *NewIP = 3102 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3103 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3104 } 3105 3106 auto *New = new (*this,TypeAlignment) 3107 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals); 3108 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3109 Types.push_back(New); 3110 return QualType(New, 0); 3111 } 3112 3113 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be 3114 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known 3115 /// sizes replaced with [*]. 3116 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const { 3117 // Vastly most common case. 3118 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type; 3119 3120 QualType result; 3121 3122 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType(); 3123 const Type *ty = split.Ty; 3124 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) { 3125 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 3126 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 3127 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 3128 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 3129 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?"); 3130 3131 // These types should never be variably-modified. 3132 case Type::Builtin: 3133 case Type::Complex: 3134 case Type::Vector: 3135 case Type::DependentVector: 3136 case Type::ExtVector: 3137 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector: 3138 case Type::DependentAddressSpace: 3139 case Type::ObjCObject: 3140 case Type::ObjCInterface: 3141 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 3142 case Type::Record: 3143 case Type::Enum: 3144 case Type::UnresolvedUsing: 3145 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 3146 case Type::TypeOf: 3147 case Type::Decltype: 3148 case Type::UnaryTransform: 3149 case Type::DependentName: 3150 case Type::InjectedClassName: 3151 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 3152 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization: 3153 case Type::TemplateTypeParm: 3154 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack: 3155 case Type::Auto: 3156 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 3157 case Type::PackExpansion: 3158 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified"); 3159 3160 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to 3161 // further decay. 3162 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 3163 case Type::FunctionProto: 3164 case Type::BlockPointer: 3165 case Type::MemberPointer: 3166 case Type::Pipe: 3167 return type; 3168 3169 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications 3170 // preserve structure except as noted by comments. 3171 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op 3172 // optimizations available here. 3173 case Type::Pointer: 3174 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType( 3175 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType())); 3176 break; 3177 3178 case Type::LValueReference: { 3179 const auto *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty); 3180 result = getLValueReferenceType( 3181 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()), 3182 lv->isSpelledAsLValue()); 3183 break; 3184 } 3185 3186 case Type::RValueReference: { 3187 const auto *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty); 3188 result = getRValueReferenceType( 3189 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType())); 3190 break; 3191 } 3192 3193 case Type::Atomic: { 3194 const auto *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty); 3195 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType())); 3196 break; 3197 } 3198 3199 case Type::ConstantArray: { 3200 const auto *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty); 3201 result = getConstantArrayType( 3202 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()), 3203 cat->getSize(), 3204 cat->getSizeModifier(), 3205 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); 3206 break; 3207 } 3208 3209 case Type::DependentSizedArray: { 3210 const auto *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty); 3211 result = getDependentSizedArrayType( 3212 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()), 3213 dat->getSizeExpr(), 3214 dat->getSizeModifier(), 3215 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 3216 dat->getBracketsRange()); 3217 break; 3218 } 3219 3220 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types. 3221 case Type::IncompleteArray: { 3222 const auto *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty); 3223 result = getVariableArrayType( 3224 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()), 3225 /*size*/ nullptr, 3226 ArrayType::Normal, 3227 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 3228 SourceRange()); 3229 break; 3230 } 3231 3232 // Turn VLA types into [*] types. 3233 case Type::VariableArray: { 3234 const auto *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty); 3235 result = getVariableArrayType( 3236 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()), 3237 /*size*/ nullptr, 3238 ArrayType::Star, 3239 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 3240 vat->getBracketsRange()); 3241 break; 3242 } 3243 } 3244 3245 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original. 3246 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals); 3247 } 3248 3249 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a 3250 /// variable array of the specified element type. 3251 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy, 3252 Expr *NumElts, 3253 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 3254 unsigned IndexTypeQuals, 3255 SourceRange Brackets) const { 3256 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's 3257 // that have an expression provided for their size. 3258 QualType Canon; 3259 3260 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type. 3261 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 3262 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split(); 3263 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM, 3264 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets); 3265 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals); 3266 } 3267 3268 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3269 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets); 3270 3271 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New); 3272 Types.push_back(New); 3273 return QualType(New, 0); 3274 } 3275 3276 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to 3277 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element 3278 /// type. 3279 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType, 3280 Expr *numElements, 3281 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 3282 unsigned elementTypeQuals, 3283 SourceRange brackets) const { 3284 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() || 3285 numElements->isValueDependent()) && 3286 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!"); 3287 3288 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number 3289 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent 3290 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay 3291 // because they can't be used in most locations. 3292 if (!numElements) { 3293 auto *newType 3294 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3295 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(), 3296 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals, 3297 brackets); 3298 Types.push_back(newType); 3299 return QualType(newType, 0); 3300 } 3301 3302 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we 3303 // also build a canonical type. 3304 3305 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split(); 3306 3307 void *insertPos = nullptr; 3308 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3309 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this, 3310 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0), 3311 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements); 3312 3313 // Look for an existing type with these properties. 3314 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy = 3315 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 3316 3317 // If we don't have one, build one. 3318 if (!canonTy) { 3319 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3320 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0), 3321 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals, 3322 brackets); 3323 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos); 3324 Types.push_back(canonTy); 3325 } 3326 3327 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array. 3328 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0), 3329 canonElementType.Quals); 3330 3331 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size 3332 // expression, then just use that as our result. 3333 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType && 3334 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements) 3335 return canon; 3336 3337 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling 3338 // of the element type. 3339 auto *sugaredType 3340 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3341 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements, 3342 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets); 3343 Types.push_back(sugaredType); 3344 return QualType(sugaredType, 0); 3345 } 3346 3347 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType, 3348 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, 3349 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const { 3350 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3351 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals); 3352 3353 void *insertPos = nullptr; 3354 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat = 3355 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) 3356 return QualType(iat, 0); 3357 3358 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 3359 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull 3360 // qualifiers off the element type. 3361 QualType canon; 3362 3363 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 3364 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split(); 3365 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), 3366 ASM, elementTypeQuals); 3367 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals); 3368 3369 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3370 IncompleteArrayType *existing = 3371 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 3372 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing; 3373 } 3374 3375 auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3376 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals); 3377 3378 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos); 3379 Types.push_back(newType); 3380 return QualType(newType, 0); 3381 } 3382 3383 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of 3384 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type. 3385 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts, 3386 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const { 3387 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType()); 3388 3389 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type. 3390 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3391 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind); 3392 3393 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3394 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3395 return QualType(VTP, 0); 3396 3397 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 3398 // so fill in the canonical type field. 3399 QualType Canonical; 3400 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) { 3401 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind); 3402 3403 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3404 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3405 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3406 } 3407 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3408 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind); 3409 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3410 Types.push_back(New); 3411 return QualType(New, 0); 3412 } 3413 3414 QualType 3415 ASTContext::getDependentVectorType(QualType VecType, Expr *SizeExpr, 3416 SourceLocation AttrLoc, 3417 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const { 3418 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3419 DependentVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(VecType), SizeExpr, 3420 VecKind); 3421 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3422 DependentVectorType *Canon = 3423 DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3424 DependentVectorType *New; 3425 3426 if (Canon) { 3427 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType( 3428 *this, VecType, QualType(Canon, 0), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind); 3429 } else { 3430 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(VecType); 3431 if (CanonVecTy == VecType) { 3432 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType( 3433 *this, VecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind); 3434 3435 DependentVectorType *CanonCheck = 3436 DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3437 assert(!CanonCheck && 3438 "Dependent-sized vector_size canonical type broken"); 3439 (void)CanonCheck; 3440 DependentVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3441 } else { 3442 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr, 3443 SourceLocation()); 3444 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType( 3445 *this, VecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind); 3446 } 3447 } 3448 3449 Types.push_back(New); 3450 return QualType(New, 0); 3451 } 3452 3453 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of 3454 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type. 3455 QualType 3456 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const { 3457 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType()); 3458 3459 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type. 3460 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3461 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector, 3462 VectorType::GenericVector); 3463 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3464 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3465 return QualType(VTP, 0); 3466 3467 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either, 3468 // so fill in the canonical type field. 3469 QualType Canonical; 3470 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) { 3471 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts); 3472 3473 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3474 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3475 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3476 } 3477 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3478 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical); 3479 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3480 Types.push_back(New); 3481 return QualType(New, 0); 3482 } 3483 3484 QualType 3485 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType, 3486 Expr *SizeExpr, 3487 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const { 3488 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3489 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType), 3490 SizeExpr); 3491 3492 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3493 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon 3494 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3495 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New; 3496 if (Canon) { 3497 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as 3498 // the canonical type for a newly-built type. 3499 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3500 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0), 3501 SizeExpr, AttrLoc); 3502 } else { 3503 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType); 3504 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) { 3505 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3506 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, 3507 AttrLoc); 3508 3509 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck 3510 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3511 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken"); 3512 (void)CanonCheck; 3513 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3514 } else { 3515 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr, 3516 SourceLocation()); 3517 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3518 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc); 3519 } 3520 } 3521 3522 Types.push_back(New); 3523 return QualType(New, 0); 3524 } 3525 3526 QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType, 3527 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr, 3528 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const { 3529 assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent()); 3530 3531 QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType); 3532 3533 void *insertPos = nullptr; 3534 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3535 DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType, 3536 AddrSpaceExpr); 3537 3538 DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy = 3539 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 3540 3541 if (!canonTy) { 3542 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3543 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, canonPointeeType, 3544 QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc); 3545 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos); 3546 Types.push_back(canonTy); 3547 } 3548 3549 if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType && 3550 canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr) 3551 return QualType(canonTy, 0); 3552 3553 auto *sugaredType 3554 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3555 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0), 3556 AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc); 3557 Types.push_back(sugaredType); 3558 return QualType(sugaredType, 0); 3559 } 3560 3561 /// Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function. 3562 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) { 3563 return T.isCanonical() && 3564 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None || 3565 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone); 3566 } 3567 3568 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'. 3569 QualType 3570 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy, 3571 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const { 3572 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular 3573 // structure. 3574 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3575 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info); 3576 3577 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3578 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT = 3579 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3580 return QualType(FT, 0); 3581 3582 QualType Canonical; 3583 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) { 3584 Canonical = 3585 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info); 3586 3587 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3588 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP = 3589 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3590 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3591 } 3592 3593 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3594 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info); 3595 Types.push_back(New); 3596 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3597 return QualType(New, 0); 3598 } 3599 3600 CanQualType 3601 ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const { 3602 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType); 3603 3604 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers. 3605 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) { 3606 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers(); 3607 Qs.removeObjCLifetime(); 3608 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe( 3609 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs)); 3610 } 3611 3612 return CanResultType; 3613 } 3614 3615 static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification( 3616 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) { 3617 if (ESI.Type == EST_None) 3618 return true; 3619 if (!NoexceptInType) 3620 return false; 3621 3622 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple 3623 // boolean "can this function type throw". 3624 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept) 3625 return true; 3626 3627 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is 3628 // value-dependent. 3629 if (ESI.Type == EST_DependentNoexcept) 3630 return true; 3631 3632 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack 3633 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its 3634 // contained types are canonical. 3635 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) { 3636 bool AnyPackExpansions = false; 3637 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) { 3638 if (!ET.isCanonical()) 3639 return false; 3640 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>()) 3641 AnyPackExpansions = true; 3642 } 3643 return AnyPackExpansions; 3644 } 3645 3646 return false; 3647 } 3648 3649 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal( 3650 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray, 3651 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const { 3652 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size(); 3653 3654 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular 3655 // structure. 3656 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3657 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI, 3658 *this, true); 3659 3660 QualType Canonical; 3661 bool Unique = false; 3662 3663 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3664 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT = 3665 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) { 3666 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0); 3667 3668 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse 3669 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent 3670 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type. 3671 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type 3672 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression. 3673 if (OnlyWantCanonical || !isComputedNoexcept(EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) || 3674 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr()) 3675 return Existing; 3676 3677 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept 3678 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't 3679 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once. 3680 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing); 3681 Unique = true; 3682 } 3683 3684 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 3685 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec = 3686 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType); 3687 3688 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not. 3689 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec && 3690 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn; 3691 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i) 3692 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam()) 3693 isCanonical = false; 3694 3695 if (OnlyWantCanonical) 3696 assert(isCanonical && 3697 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type"); 3698 3699 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't 3700 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the 3701 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards. 3702 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) { 3703 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs; 3704 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs); 3705 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i) 3706 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i])); 3707 3708 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage; 3709 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI; 3710 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 3711 3712 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) { 3713 // Exception spec is already OK. 3714 } else if (NoexceptInType) { 3715 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) { 3716 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated: 3717 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one 3718 // should ever look at this. 3719 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3720 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny: case EST_NoexceptFalse: 3721 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None; 3722 break; 3723 3724 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept", 3725 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types. 3726 case EST_Dynamic: { 3727 bool AnyPacks = false; 3728 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) { 3729 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>()) 3730 AnyPacks = true; 3731 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET)); 3732 } 3733 if (!AnyPacks) 3734 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None; 3735 else { 3736 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic; 3737 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage; 3738 } 3739 break; 3740 } 3741 3742 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept: case EST_NoexceptTrue: 3743 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept; 3744 break; 3745 3746 case EST_DependentNoexcept: 3747 llvm_unreachable("dependent noexcept is already canonical"); 3748 } 3749 } else { 3750 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo(); 3751 } 3752 3753 // Adjust the canonical function result type. 3754 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy); 3755 Canonical = 3756 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true); 3757 3758 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3759 FunctionProtoType *NewIP = 3760 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3761 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 3762 } 3763 3764 // Compute the needed size to hold this FunctionProtoType and the 3765 // various trailing objects. 3766 auto ESH = FunctionProtoType::getExceptionSpecSize( 3767 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type, EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size()); 3768 size_t Size = FunctionProtoType::totalSizeToAlloc< 3769 QualType, FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraBitfields, 3770 FunctionType::ExceptionType, Expr *, FunctionDecl *, 3771 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo>( 3772 NumArgs, FunctionProtoType::hasExtraBitfields(EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type), 3773 ESH.NumExceptionType, ESH.NumExprPtr, ESH.NumFunctionDeclPtr, 3774 EPI.ExtParameterInfos ? NumArgs : 0); 3775 3776 auto *FTP = (FunctionProtoType *)Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment); 3777 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI; 3778 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI); 3779 Types.push_back(FTP); 3780 if (!Unique) 3781 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos); 3782 return QualType(FTP, 0); 3783 } 3784 3785 QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const { 3786 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3787 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly); 3788 3789 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3790 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3791 return QualType(PT, 0); 3792 3793 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 3794 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 3795 QualType Canonical; 3796 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 3797 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly); 3798 3799 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 3800 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3801 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); 3802 (void)NewIP; 3803 } 3804 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly); 3805 Types.push_back(New); 3806 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 3807 return QualType(New, 0); 3808 } 3809 3810 QualType ASTContext::adjustStringLiteralBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 3811 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space. 3812 return LangOpts.OpenCL ? getAddrSpaceQualType(Ty, LangAS::opencl_constant) 3813 : Ty; 3814 } 3815 3816 QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const { 3817 return getPipeType(T, true); 3818 } 3819 3820 QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const { 3821 return getPipeType(T, false); 3822 } 3823 3824 #ifndef NDEBUG 3825 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) { 3826 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false; 3827 const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 3828 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD)) 3829 return true; 3830 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() && 3831 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD)) 3832 return true; 3833 return false; 3834 } 3835 #endif 3836 3837 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the 3838 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration. 3839 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl, 3840 QualType TST) const { 3841 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl)); 3842 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) { 3843 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl)); 3844 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) { 3845 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type"); 3846 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl; 3847 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl)); 3848 } else { 3849 Type *newType = 3850 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST); 3851 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3852 Types.push_back(newType); 3853 } 3854 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3855 } 3856 3857 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 3858 /// specified type declaration. 3859 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const { 3860 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param"); 3861 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case"); 3862 3863 if (const auto *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl)) 3864 return getTypedefType(Typedef); 3865 3866 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) && 3867 "Template type parameter types are always available."); 3868 3869 if (const auto *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) { 3870 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration"); 3871 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record)); 3872 return getRecordType(Record); 3873 } else if (const auto *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) { 3874 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration"); 3875 return getEnumType(Enum); 3876 } else if (const auto *Using = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) { 3877 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using); 3878 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3879 Types.push_back(newType); 3880 } else 3881 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?"); 3882 3883 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3884 } 3885 3886 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 3887 /// specified typedef name decl. 3888 QualType 3889 ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 3890 QualType Canonical) const { 3891 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3892 3893 if (Canonical.isNull()) 3894 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType()); 3895 auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3896 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical); 3897 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3898 Types.push_back(newType); 3899 return QualType(newType, 0); 3900 } 3901 3902 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const { 3903 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3904 3905 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) 3906 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl) 3907 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3908 3909 auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl); 3910 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3911 Types.push_back(newType); 3912 return QualType(newType, 0); 3913 } 3914 3915 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const { 3916 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3917 3918 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) 3919 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl) 3920 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 3921 3922 auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl); 3923 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType; 3924 Types.push_back(newType); 3925 return QualType(newType, 0); 3926 } 3927 3928 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(attr::Kind attrKind, 3929 QualType modifiedType, 3930 QualType equivalentType) { 3931 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id; 3932 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType); 3933 3934 void *insertPos = nullptr; 3935 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos); 3936 if (type) return QualType(type, 0); 3937 3938 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType); 3939 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3940 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType); 3941 3942 Types.push_back(type); 3943 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos); 3944 3945 return QualType(type, 0); 3946 } 3947 3948 /// Retrieve a substitution-result type. 3949 QualType 3950 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm, 3951 QualType Replacement) const { 3952 assert(Replacement.isCanonical() 3953 && "replacement types must always be canonical"); 3954 3955 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3956 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement); 3957 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3958 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm 3959 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3960 3961 if (!SubstParm) { 3962 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 3963 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement); 3964 Types.push_back(SubstParm); 3965 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos); 3966 } 3967 3968 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 3969 } 3970 3971 /// Retrieve a 3972 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType( 3973 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm, 3974 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) { 3975 #ifndef NDEBUG 3976 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) { 3977 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type"); 3978 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type"); 3979 } 3980 #endif 3981 3982 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3983 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack); 3984 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 3985 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm 3986 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 3987 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 3988 3989 QualType Canon; 3990 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) { 3991 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0)); 3992 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon), 3993 ArgPack); 3994 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 3995 } 3996 3997 auto *SubstParm 3998 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon, 3999 ArgPack); 4000 Types.push_back(SubstParm); 4001 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos); 4002 return QualType(SubstParm, 0); 4003 } 4004 4005 /// Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template 4006 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally) 4007 /// name. 4008 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index, 4009 bool ParameterPack, 4010 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const { 4011 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4012 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl); 4013 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4014 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm 4015 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4016 4017 if (TypeParm) 4018 return QualType(TypeParm, 0); 4019 4020 if (TTPDecl) { 4021 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack); 4022 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon); 4023 4024 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck 4025 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4026 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken"); 4027 (void)TypeCheck; 4028 } else 4029 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4030 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack); 4031 4032 Types.push_back(TypeParm); 4033 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos); 4034 4035 return QualType(TypeParm, 0); 4036 } 4037 4038 TypeSourceInfo * 4039 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name, 4040 SourceLocation NameLoc, 4041 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args, 4042 QualType Underlying) const { 4043 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 4044 "No dependent template names here!"); 4045 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying); 4046 4047 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST); 4048 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL = 4049 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>(); 4050 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 4051 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc); 4052 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc()); 4053 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc()); 4054 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) 4055 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo()); 4056 return DI; 4057 } 4058 4059 QualType 4060 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, 4061 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args, 4062 QualType Underlying) const { 4063 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 4064 "No dependent template names here!"); 4065 4066 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec; 4067 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size()); 4068 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments()) 4069 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument()); 4070 4071 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying); 4072 } 4073 4074 #ifndef NDEBUG 4075 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) { 4076 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args) 4077 if (Arg.isPackExpansion()) 4078 return true; 4079 4080 return true; 4081 } 4082 #endif 4083 4084 QualType 4085 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, 4086 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args, 4087 QualType Underlying) const { 4088 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 4089 "No dependent template names here!"); 4090 // Look through qualified template names. 4091 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()) 4092 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl()); 4093 4094 bool IsTypeAlias = 4095 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() && 4096 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl()); 4097 QualType CanonType; 4098 if (!Underlying.isNull()) 4099 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying); 4100 else { 4101 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains 4102 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack. 4103 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) && 4104 "Caller must compute aliased type"); 4105 IsTypeAlias = false; 4106 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args); 4107 } 4108 4109 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't 4110 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that 4111 // we don't unique and don't want to lose. 4112 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) + 4113 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() + 4114 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0), 4115 TypeAlignment); 4116 auto *Spec 4117 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType, 4118 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType()); 4119 4120 Types.push_back(Spec); 4121 return QualType(Spec, 0); 4122 } 4123 4124 QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType( 4125 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const { 4126 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() && 4127 "No dependent template names here!"); 4128 4129 // Look through qualified template names. 4130 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()) 4131 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl()); 4132 4133 // Build the canonical template specialization type. 4134 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template); 4135 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs; 4136 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size(); 4137 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs); 4138 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args) 4139 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg)); 4140 4141 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already 4142 // exists. 4143 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4144 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate, 4145 CanonArgs, *this); 4146 4147 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4148 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec 4149 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4150 4151 if (!Spec) { 4152 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type. 4153 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) + 4154 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs), 4155 TypeAlignment); 4156 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate, 4157 CanonArgs, 4158 QualType(), QualType()); 4159 Types.push_back(Spec); 4160 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos); 4161 } 4162 4163 assert(Spec->isDependentType() && 4164 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type"); 4165 return QualType(Spec, 0); 4166 } 4167 4168 QualType ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 4169 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 4170 QualType NamedType, 4171 TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) const { 4172 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4173 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType, OwnedTagDecl); 4174 4175 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4176 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4177 if (T) 4178 return QualType(T, 0); 4179 4180 QualType Canon = NamedType; 4181 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) { 4182 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType); 4183 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4184 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken"); 4185 (void)CheckT; 4186 } 4187 4188 void *Mem = Allocate(ElaboratedType::totalSizeToAlloc<TagDecl *>(!!OwnedTagDecl), 4189 TypeAlignment); 4190 T = new (Mem) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon, OwnedTagDecl); 4191 4192 Types.push_back(T); 4193 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4194 return QualType(T, 0); 4195 } 4196 4197 QualType 4198 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const { 4199 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4200 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType); 4201 4202 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4203 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4204 if (T) 4205 return QualType(T, 0); 4206 4207 QualType Canon = InnerType; 4208 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) { 4209 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType); 4210 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4211 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken"); 4212 (void)CheckT; 4213 } 4214 4215 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon); 4216 Types.push_back(T); 4217 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4218 return QualType(T, 0); 4219 } 4220 4221 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 4222 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 4223 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 4224 QualType Canon) const { 4225 if (Canon.isNull()) { 4226 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 4227 if (CanonNNS != NNS) 4228 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name); 4229 } 4230 4231 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4232 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name); 4233 4234 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4235 DependentNameType *T 4236 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4237 if (T) 4238 return QualType(T, 0); 4239 4240 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon); 4241 Types.push_back(T); 4242 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4243 return QualType(T, 0); 4244 } 4245 4246 QualType 4247 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType( 4248 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 4249 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 4250 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 4251 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const { 4252 // TODO: avoid this copy 4253 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy; 4254 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I) 4255 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument()); 4256 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy); 4257 } 4258 4259 QualType 4260 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType( 4261 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, 4262 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 4263 const IdentifierInfo *Name, 4264 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const { 4265 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 4266 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent"); 4267 4268 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4269 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS, 4270 Name, Args); 4271 4272 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4273 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T 4274 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4275 if (T) 4276 return QualType(T, 0); 4277 4278 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 4279 4280 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword; 4281 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename; 4282 4283 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false; 4284 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size(); 4285 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs); 4286 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) { 4287 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]); 4288 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I])) 4289 AnyNonCanonArgs = true; 4290 } 4291 4292 QualType Canon; 4293 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) { 4294 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, 4295 Name, 4296 CanonArgs); 4297 4298 // Find the insert position again. 4299 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4300 } 4301 4302 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) + 4303 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs), 4304 TypeAlignment); 4305 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, 4306 Name, Args, Canon); 4307 Types.push_back(T); 4308 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4309 return QualType(T, 0); 4310 } 4311 4312 TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) { 4313 TemplateArgument Arg; 4314 if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) { 4315 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP); 4316 if (TTP->isParameterPack()) 4317 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None); 4318 4319 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType); 4320 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) { 4321 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr( 4322 NTTP, /*enclosing*/false, 4323 NTTP->getType().getNonLValueExprType(*this), 4324 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation()); 4325 4326 if (NTTP->isParameterPack()) 4327 E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(), 4328 None); 4329 Arg = TemplateArgument(E); 4330 } else { 4331 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param); 4332 if (TTP->isParameterPack()) 4333 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>()); 4334 else 4335 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP)); 4336 } 4337 4338 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack()) 4339 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg); 4340 4341 return Arg; 4342 } 4343 4344 void 4345 ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params, 4346 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) { 4347 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size()); 4348 4349 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params) 4350 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param)); 4351 } 4352 4353 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern, 4354 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) { 4355 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4356 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions); 4357 4358 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() && 4359 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs"); 4360 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4361 PackExpansionType *T 4362 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4363 if (T) 4364 return QualType(T, 0); 4365 4366 QualType Canon; 4367 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) { 4368 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern); 4369 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it 4370 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its 4371 // parameters. 4372 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) { 4373 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions); 4374 4375 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into 4376 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position. 4377 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4378 } 4379 } 4380 4381 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4382 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions); 4383 Types.push_back(T); 4384 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4385 return QualType(T, 0); 4386 } 4387 4388 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols 4389 /// alphabetically. 4390 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS, 4391 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) { 4392 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName()); 4393 } 4394 4395 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) { 4396 if (Protocols.empty()) return true; 4397 4398 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0]) 4399 return false; 4400 4401 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i) 4402 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 || 4403 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i]) 4404 return false; 4405 return true; 4406 } 4407 4408 static void 4409 SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) { 4410 // Sort protocols, keyed by name. 4411 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames); 4412 4413 // Canonicalize. 4414 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols) 4415 P = P->getCanonicalDecl(); 4416 4417 // Remove duplicates. 4418 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end()); 4419 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end()); 4420 } 4421 4422 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType, 4423 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols, 4424 unsigned NumProtocols) const { 4425 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {}, 4426 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols), 4427 /*isKindOf=*/false); 4428 } 4429 4430 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType( 4431 QualType baseType, 4432 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, 4433 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, 4434 bool isKindOf) const { 4435 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or 4436 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine. 4437 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf && 4438 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType)) 4439 return baseType; 4440 4441 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 4442 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4443 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf); 4444 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4445 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4446 return QualType(QT, 0); 4447 4448 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization, 4449 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base 4450 // type. 4451 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs; 4452 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) { 4453 if (const auto *baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 4454 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs(); 4455 } 4456 4457 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a 4458 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments 4459 // canonicalized. 4460 QualType canonical; 4461 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(), 4462 effectiveTypeArgs.end(), 4463 [&](QualType type) { 4464 return type.isCanonical(); 4465 }); 4466 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols); 4467 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) { 4468 // Determine the canonical type arguments. 4469 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs; 4470 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec; 4471 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) { 4472 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size()); 4473 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs) 4474 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg)); 4475 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec; 4476 } else { 4477 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs; 4478 } 4479 4480 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols; 4481 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec; 4482 if (!protocolsSorted) { 4483 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end()); 4484 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec); 4485 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec; 4486 } else { 4487 canonProtocols = protocols; 4488 } 4489 4490 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs, 4491 canonProtocols, isKindOf); 4492 4493 // Regenerate InsertPos. 4494 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4495 } 4496 4497 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl); 4498 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType); 4499 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *); 4500 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment); 4501 auto *T = 4502 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, 4503 isKindOf); 4504 4505 Types.push_back(T); 4506 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos); 4507 return QualType(T, 0); 4508 } 4509 4510 /// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type. 4511 /// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply 4512 /// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType. 4513 QualType 4514 ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type, 4515 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError, 4516 bool allowOnPointerType) const { 4517 hasError = false; 4518 4519 if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) { 4520 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols); 4521 } 4522 4523 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType. 4524 if (allowOnPointerType) { 4525 if (const auto *objPtr = 4526 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) { 4527 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType(); 4528 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType. 4529 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec; 4530 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(), 4531 objT->qual_end()); 4532 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end()); 4533 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec; 4534 type = getObjCObjectType( 4535 objT->getBaseType(), 4536 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(), 4537 protocols, 4538 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten()); 4539 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type); 4540 } 4541 } 4542 4543 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType. 4544 if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){ 4545 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already 4546 // known to conform. 4547 4548 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(), 4549 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(), 4550 protocols, 4551 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten()); 4552 } 4553 4554 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ... 4555 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) { 4556 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers. 4557 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do. 4558 4559 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already 4560 // known to conform. 4561 return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false); 4562 } 4563 4564 // id<protocol-list> 4565 if (type->isObjCIdType()) { 4566 const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4567 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols, 4568 objPtr->isKindOfType()); 4569 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type); 4570 } 4571 4572 // Class<protocol-list> 4573 if (type->isObjCClassType()) { 4574 const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4575 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols, 4576 objPtr->isKindOfType()); 4577 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type); 4578 } 4579 4580 hasError = true; 4581 return type; 4582 } 4583 4584 QualType 4585 ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl, 4586 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, 4587 QualType Canonical) const { 4588 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 4589 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4590 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols); 4591 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4592 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam = 4593 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4594 return QualType(TypeParam, 0); 4595 4596 if (Canonical.isNull()) { 4597 // We canonicalize to the underlying type. 4598 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType()); 4599 if (!protocols.empty()) { 4600 // Apply the protocol qualifers. 4601 bool hasError; 4602 Canonical = getCanonicalType(applyObjCProtocolQualifiers( 4603 Canonical, protocols, hasError, true /*allowOnPointerType*/)); 4604 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type"); 4605 } 4606 } 4607 4608 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType); 4609 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *); 4610 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment); 4611 auto *newType = new (mem) ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols); 4612 4613 Types.push_back(newType); 4614 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos); 4615 return QualType(newType, 0); 4616 } 4617 4618 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's 4619 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol 4620 /// list. 4621 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT, 4622 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) { 4623 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 4624 return false; 4625 4626 if (const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4627 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 4628 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 4629 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false)) 4630 return false; 4631 } 4632 return true; 4633 } 4634 return false; 4635 } 4636 4637 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in 4638 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list 4639 /// of protocols. 4640 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT, 4641 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) { 4642 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 4643 return false; 4644 const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4645 if (!OPT) 4646 return false; 4647 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition()) 4648 return false; 4649 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols; 4650 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols); 4651 if (InheritedProtocols.empty()) 4652 return false; 4653 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protocol 4654 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok. 4655 bool Conforms = false; 4656 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 4657 Conforms = false; 4658 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) { 4659 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) { 4660 Conforms = true; 4661 break; 4662 } 4663 } 4664 if (!Conforms) 4665 break; 4666 } 4667 if (Conforms) 4668 return true; 4669 4670 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) { 4671 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 4672 bool Adopts = false; 4673 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 4674 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto 4675 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto))) 4676 break; 4677 } 4678 if (!Adopts) 4679 return false; 4680 } 4681 return true; 4682 } 4683 4684 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for 4685 /// the given object type. 4686 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const { 4687 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4688 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT); 4689 4690 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4691 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT = 4692 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4693 return QualType(QT, 0); 4694 4695 // Find the canonical object type. 4696 QualType Canonical; 4697 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) { 4698 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT)); 4699 4700 // Regenerate InsertPos. 4701 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4702 } 4703 4704 // No match. 4705 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment); 4706 auto *QType = 4707 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT); 4708 4709 Types.push_back(QType); 4710 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos); 4711 return QualType(QType, 0); 4712 } 4713 4714 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 4715 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional. 4716 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl, 4717 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const { 4718 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) 4719 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0); 4720 4721 if (PrevDecl) { 4722 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl"); 4723 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl; 4724 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0); 4725 } 4726 4727 // Prefer the definition, if there is one. 4728 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition()) 4729 Decl = Def; 4730 4731 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment); 4732 auto *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl); 4733 Decl->TypeForDecl = T; 4734 Types.push_back(T); 4735 return QualType(T, 0); 4736 } 4737 4738 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique 4739 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example, 4740 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different 4741 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates 4742 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique). 4743 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const { 4744 TypeOfExprType *toe; 4745 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) { 4746 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4747 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr); 4748 4749 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4750 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon 4751 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4752 if (Canon) { 4753 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent 4754 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type. 4755 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, 4756 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0)); 4757 } else { 4758 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type. 4759 Canon 4760 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr); 4761 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos); 4762 toe = Canon; 4763 } 4764 } else { 4765 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType()); 4766 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical); 4767 } 4768 Types.push_back(toe); 4769 return QualType(toe, 0); 4770 } 4771 4772 /// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique 4773 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be 4774 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be 4775 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates 4776 /// on canonical types (which are always unique). 4777 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const { 4778 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType); 4779 auto *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical); 4780 Types.push_back(tot); 4781 return QualType(tot, 0); 4782 } 4783 4784 /// Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType 4785 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own 4786 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there 4787 /// is an Expr tree under each such type. 4788 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const { 4789 DecltypeType *dt; 4790 4791 // C++11 [temp.type]p2: 4792 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a 4793 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same 4794 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1). 4795 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) { 4796 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4797 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e); 4798 4799 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4800 DependentDecltypeType *Canon 4801 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4802 if (!Canon) { 4803 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type. 4804 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e); 4805 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos); 4806 } 4807 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4808 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0)); 4809 } else { 4810 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4811 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType)); 4812 } 4813 Types.push_back(dt); 4814 return QualType(dt, 0); 4815 } 4816 4817 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory 4818 /// savings are minimal and these are rare. 4819 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType, 4820 QualType UnderlyingType, 4821 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind) 4822 const { 4823 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr; 4824 4825 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) { 4826 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 4827 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4828 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind); 4829 4830 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4831 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon 4832 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4833 4834 if (!Canon) { 4835 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type. 4836 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4837 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType), 4838 Kind); 4839 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos); 4840 } 4841 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, 4842 QualType(), Kind, 4843 QualType(Canon, 0)); 4844 } else { 4845 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType); 4846 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, 4847 UnderlyingType, Kind, 4848 CanonType); 4849 } 4850 Types.push_back(ut); 4851 return QualType(ut, 0); 4852 } 4853 4854 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been 4855 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the 4856 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type. 4857 QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword, 4858 bool IsDependent) const { 4859 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent) 4860 return getAutoDeductType(); 4861 4862 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 4863 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4864 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4865 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent); 4866 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4867 return QualType(AT, 0); 4868 4869 auto *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4870 AutoType(DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent); 4871 Types.push_back(AT); 4872 if (InsertPos) 4873 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos); 4874 return QualType(AT, 0); 4875 } 4876 4877 /// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type 4878 /// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 4879 /// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type. 4880 QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType( 4881 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const { 4882 // Look in the folding set for an existing type. 4883 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4884 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4885 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType, 4886 IsDependent); 4887 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST = 4888 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4889 return QualType(DTST, 0); 4890 4891 auto *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment) 4892 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent); 4893 Types.push_back(DTST); 4894 if (InsertPos) 4895 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos); 4896 return QualType(DTST, 0); 4897 } 4898 4899 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for 4900 /// the given value type. 4901 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const { 4902 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular 4903 // structure. 4904 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 4905 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T); 4906 4907 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 4908 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) 4909 return QualType(AT, 0); 4910 4911 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type 4912 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. 4913 QualType Canonical; 4914 if (!T.isCanonical()) { 4915 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T)); 4916 4917 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about. 4918 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 4919 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP; 4920 } 4921 auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical); 4922 Types.push_back(New); 4923 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos); 4924 return QualType(New, 0); 4925 } 4926 4927 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'. 4928 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const { 4929 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull()) 4930 AutoDeductTy = QualType( 4931 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto, 4932 /*dependent*/false), 4933 0); 4934 return AutoDeductTy; 4935 } 4936 4937 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'. 4938 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const { 4939 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull()) 4940 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType()); 4941 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern"); 4942 return AutoRRefDeductTy; 4943 } 4944 4945 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the 4946 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl. 4947 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const { 4948 assert(Decl); 4949 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting 4950 // away const? mutable? 4951 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl)); 4952 } 4953 4954 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result 4955 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and 4956 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>. 4957 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const { 4958 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType()); 4959 } 4960 4961 /// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type 4962 /// corresponding to size_t. 4963 CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const { 4964 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType()); 4965 } 4966 4967 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5). 4968 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const { 4969 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType()); 4970 } 4971 4972 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5). 4973 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const { 4974 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType()); 4975 } 4976 4977 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t". 4978 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension. 4979 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const { 4980 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ? 4981 return WCharTy; 4982 } 4983 4984 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t". 4985 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension. 4986 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const { 4987 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ? 4988 return UnsignedIntTy; 4989 } 4990 4991 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const { 4992 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType()); 4993 } 4994 4995 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const { 4996 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType()); 4997 } 4998 4999 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17) 5000 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9). 5001 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const { 5002 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0)); 5003 } 5004 5005 /// Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t" 5006 /// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type 5007 /// in the definition of %tu format specifier. 5008 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const { 5009 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(0)); 5010 } 5011 5012 /// Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in 5013 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork(). 5014 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const { 5015 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType()); 5016 } 5017 5018 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5019 // Type Operators 5020 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5021 5022 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const { 5023 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining 5024 // qualifiers. 5025 T = getCanonicalType(T); 5026 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 5027 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); 5028 QualType Result; 5029 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) { 5030 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0)); 5031 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) { 5032 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0)); 5033 } else { 5034 Result = QualType(Ty, 0); 5035 } 5036 5037 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result); 5038 } 5039 5040 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type, 5041 Qualifiers &quals) { 5042 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType(); 5043 5044 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to 5045 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor. 5046 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with 5047 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly. 5048 const auto *AT = 5049 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); 5050 5051 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType. 5052 if (!AT) { 5053 quals = splitType.Quals; 5054 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0); 5055 } 5056 5057 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type. 5058 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType(); 5059 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals); 5060 5061 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we 5062 // can just use the results in splitType. 5063 if (elementType == unqualElementType) { 5064 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call 5065 quals = splitType.Quals; 5066 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0); 5067 } 5068 5069 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then 5070 // build the type back up. 5071 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals); 5072 5073 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) { 5074 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(), 5075 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0); 5076 } 5077 5078 if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) { 5079 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0); 5080 } 5081 5082 if (const auto *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) { 5083 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType, 5084 VAT->getSizeExpr(), 5085 VAT->getSizeModifier(), 5086 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 5087 VAT->getBracketsRange()); 5088 } 5089 5090 const auto *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT); 5091 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(), 5092 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0, 5093 SourceRange()); 5094 } 5095 5096 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may both be array types with the same bound 5097 /// (or both be array types of unknown bound) for the purpose of comparing the 5098 /// cv-decomposition of two types per C++ [conv.qual]. 5099 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) { 5100 bool UnwrappedAny = false; 5101 while (true) { 5102 auto *AT1 = getAsArrayType(T1); 5103 if (!AT1) return UnwrappedAny; 5104 5105 auto *AT2 = getAsArrayType(T2); 5106 if (!AT2) return UnwrappedAny; 5107 5108 // If we don't have two array types with the same constant bound nor two 5109 // incomplete array types, we've unwrapped everything we can. 5110 if (auto *CAT1 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT1)) { 5111 auto *CAT2 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT2); 5112 if (!CAT2 || CAT1->getSize() != CAT2->getSize()) 5113 return UnwrappedAny; 5114 } else if (!isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT1) || 5115 !isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT2)) { 5116 return UnwrappedAny; 5117 } 5118 5119 T1 = AT1->getElementType(); 5120 T2 = AT2->getElementType(); 5121 UnwrappedAny = true; 5122 } 5123 } 5124 5125 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may be similar (C++ [conv.qual]). 5126 /// 5127 /// If T1 and T2 are both pointer types of the same kind, or both array types 5128 /// with the same bound, unwraps layers from T1 and T2 until a pointer type is 5129 /// unwrapped. Top-level qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. 5130 /// 5131 /// This function will typically be called in a loop that successively 5132 /// "unwraps" pointer and pointer-to-member types to compare them at each 5133 /// level. 5134 /// 5135 /// \return \c true if a pointer type was unwrapped, \c false if we reached a 5136 /// pair of types that can't be unwrapped further. 5137 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) { 5138 UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(T1, T2); 5139 5140 const auto *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(); 5141 const auto *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>(); 5142 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) { 5143 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType(); 5144 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType(); 5145 return true; 5146 } 5147 5148 const auto *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 5149 const auto *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 5150 if (T1MPType && T2MPType && 5151 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0), 5152 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) { 5153 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType(); 5154 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType(); 5155 return true; 5156 } 5157 5158 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 5159 const auto *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5160 const auto *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5161 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) { 5162 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType(); 5163 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType(); 5164 return true; 5165 } 5166 } 5167 5168 // FIXME: Block pointers, too? 5169 5170 return false; 5171 } 5172 5173 bool ASTContext::hasSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) { 5174 while (true) { 5175 Qualifiers Quals; 5176 T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 5177 T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 5178 if (hasSameType(T1, T2)) 5179 return true; 5180 if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) 5181 return false; 5182 } 5183 } 5184 5185 bool ASTContext::hasCvrSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) { 5186 while (true) { 5187 Qualifiers Quals1, Quals2; 5188 T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals1); 5189 T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals2); 5190 5191 Quals1.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5192 Quals2.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5193 if (Quals1 != Quals2) 5194 return false; 5195 5196 if (hasSameType(T1, T2)) 5197 return true; 5198 5199 if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) 5200 return false; 5201 } 5202 } 5203 5204 DeclarationNameInfo 5205 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name, 5206 SourceLocation NameLoc) const { 5207 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5208 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate: 5209 case TemplateName::Template: 5210 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc? 5211 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(), 5212 NameLoc); 5213 5214 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: { 5215 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate(); 5216 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc? 5217 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc); 5218 } 5219 5220 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: { 5221 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName(); 5222 DeclarationName DName; 5223 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) { 5224 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier()); 5225 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc); 5226 } else { 5227 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator()); 5228 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations? 5229 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc; 5230 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding(); 5231 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding(); 5232 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc); 5233 } 5234 } 5235 5236 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: { 5237 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 5238 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm(); 5239 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(), 5240 NameLoc); 5241 } 5242 5243 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: { 5244 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst 5245 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(); 5246 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(), 5247 NameLoc); 5248 } 5249 } 5250 5251 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!"); 5252 } 5253 5254 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const { 5255 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5256 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate: 5257 case TemplateName::Template: { 5258 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5259 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template)) 5260 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP); 5261 5262 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration. 5263 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl())); 5264 } 5265 5266 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: 5267 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template"); 5268 5269 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: { 5270 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName(); 5271 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls."); 5272 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName; 5273 } 5274 5275 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: { 5276 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 5277 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm(); 5278 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement()); 5279 } 5280 5281 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: { 5282 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst 5283 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(); 5284 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter 5285 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack()); 5286 TemplateArgument canonArgPack 5287 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack()); 5288 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack); 5289 } 5290 } 5291 5292 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!"); 5293 } 5294 5295 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) { 5296 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X); 5297 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y); 5298 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer(); 5299 } 5300 5301 TemplateArgument 5302 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const { 5303 switch (Arg.getKind()) { 5304 case TemplateArgument::Null: 5305 return Arg; 5306 5307 case TemplateArgument::Expression: 5308 return Arg; 5309 5310 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: { 5311 auto *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 5312 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl()); 5313 } 5314 5315 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr: 5316 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()), 5317 /*isNullPtr*/true); 5318 5319 case TemplateArgument::Template: 5320 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate())); 5321 5322 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion: 5323 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName( 5324 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()), 5325 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions()); 5326 5327 case TemplateArgument::Integral: 5328 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType())); 5329 5330 case TemplateArgument::Type: 5331 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType())); 5332 5333 case TemplateArgument::Pack: { 5334 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0) 5335 return Arg; 5336 5337 auto *CanonArgs = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()]; 5338 unsigned Idx = 0; 5339 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(), 5340 AEnd = Arg.pack_end(); 5341 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx) 5342 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A); 5343 5344 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size())); 5345 } 5346 } 5347 5348 // Silence GCC warning 5349 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind"); 5350 } 5351 5352 NestedNameSpecifier * 5353 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const { 5354 if (!NNS) 5355 return nullptr; 5356 5357 switch (NNS->getKind()) { 5358 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: 5359 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same. 5360 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 5361 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()), 5362 NNS->getAsIdentifier()); 5363 5364 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: 5365 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with 5366 // this namespace and no prefix. 5367 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, 5368 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace()); 5369 5370 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: 5371 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with 5372 // this namespace and no prefix. 5373 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, 5374 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace() 5375 ->getOriginalNamespace()); 5376 5377 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: 5378 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: { 5379 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0)); 5380 5381 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"), 5382 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those 5383 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize 5384 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name 5385 // types, e.g., 5386 // typedef typename T::type T1; 5387 // typedef typename T1::type T2; 5388 if (const auto *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>()) 5389 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(), 5390 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier())); 5391 5392 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec. 5393 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the 5394 // first place? 5395 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false, 5396 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr())); 5397 } 5398 5399 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: 5400 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: 5401 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique. 5402 return NNS; 5403 } 5404 5405 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!"); 5406 } 5407 5408 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const { 5409 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently. 5410 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) { 5411 // Handle the common positive case fast. 5412 if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T)) 5413 return AT; 5414 } 5415 5416 // Handle the common negative case fast. 5417 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType())) 5418 return nullptr; 5419 5420 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This 5421 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes 5422 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type." 5423 5424 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have 5425 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type 5426 // we must propagate them down into the element type. 5427 5428 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType(); 5429 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals; 5430 5431 // If we have a simple case, just return now. 5432 const auto *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty); 5433 if (!ATy || qs.empty()) 5434 return ATy; 5435 5436 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the 5437 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type. 5438 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs); 5439 5440 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy)) 5441 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(), 5442 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 5443 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers())); 5444 if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy)) 5445 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy, 5446 IAT->getSizeModifier(), 5447 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers())); 5448 5449 if (const auto *DSAT = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy)) 5450 return cast<ArrayType>( 5451 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy, 5452 DSAT->getSizeExpr(), 5453 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 5454 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 5455 DSAT->getBracketsRange())); 5456 5457 const auto *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy); 5458 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy, 5459 VAT->getSizeExpr(), 5460 VAT->getSizeModifier(), 5461 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), 5462 VAT->getBracketsRange())); 5463 } 5464 5465 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const { 5466 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) 5467 return getDecayedType(T); 5468 return T; 5469 } 5470 5471 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const { 5472 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 5473 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T); 5474 return T.getUnqualifiedType(); 5475 } 5476 5477 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const { 5478 // C++ [except.throw]p3: 5479 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception 5480 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level 5481 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting 5482 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T" 5483 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...] 5484 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T); 5485 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) 5486 T = getDecayedType(T); 5487 return T.getUnqualifiedType(); 5488 } 5489 5490 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the 5491 /// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when 5492 /// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type, 5493 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array. 5494 /// 5495 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3. 5496 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const { 5497 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any 5498 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation 5499 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present 5500 // (C99 6.7.3p8). 5501 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty); 5502 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!"); 5503 5504 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType()); 5505 5506 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict 5507 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy, 5508 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers()); 5509 5510 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable 5511 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) { 5512 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType( 5513 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result); 5514 } 5515 return Result; 5516 } 5517 5518 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const { 5519 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType()); 5520 } 5521 5522 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const { 5523 Qualifiers qs; 5524 while (true) { 5525 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType(); 5526 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe(); 5527 if (!array) break; 5528 5529 type = array->getElementType(); 5530 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals); 5531 } 5532 5533 return getQualifiedType(type, qs); 5534 } 5535 5536 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements. 5537 uint64_t 5538 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const { 5539 uint64_t ElementCount = 1; 5540 do { 5541 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue(); 5542 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>( 5543 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()); 5544 } while (CA); 5545 return ElementCount; 5546 } 5547 5548 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types. 5549 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float. 5550 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) { 5551 if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>()) 5552 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType()); 5553 5554 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type"); 5555 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) { 5556 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type"); 5557 case BuiltinType::Float16: return Float16Rank; 5558 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank; 5559 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank; 5560 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank; 5561 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank; 5562 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank; 5563 } 5564 } 5565 5566 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating 5567 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize). 5568 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type. 5569 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type. 5570 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size, 5571 QualType Domain) const { 5572 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size); 5573 if (Domain->isComplexType()) { 5574 switch (EltRank) { 5575 case Float16Rank: 5576 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported"); 5577 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy; 5578 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy; 5579 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy; 5580 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy; 5581 } 5582 } 5583 5584 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!"); 5585 switch (EltRank) { 5586 case Float16Rank: return HalfTy; 5587 case HalfRank: return HalfTy; 5588 case FloatRank: return FloatTy; 5589 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy; 5590 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy; 5591 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty; 5592 } 5593 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank"); 5594 } 5595 5596 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating 5597 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' == 5598 /// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If 5599 /// LHS < RHS, return -1. 5600 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const { 5601 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS); 5602 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS); 5603 5604 if (LHSR == RHSR) 5605 return 0; 5606 if (LHSR > RHSR) 5607 return 1; 5608 return -1; 5609 } 5610 5611 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This 5612 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum, 5613 /// or if it is not canonicalized. 5614 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const { 5615 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized"); 5616 5617 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) { 5618 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer"); 5619 case BuiltinType::Bool: 5620 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3); 5621 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 5622 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 5623 case BuiltinType::SChar: 5624 case BuiltinType::UChar: 5625 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3); 5626 case BuiltinType::Short: 5627 case BuiltinType::UShort: 5628 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3); 5629 case BuiltinType::Int: 5630 case BuiltinType::UInt: 5631 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3); 5632 case BuiltinType::Long: 5633 case BuiltinType::ULong: 5634 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3); 5635 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 5636 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 5637 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3); 5638 case BuiltinType::Int128: 5639 case BuiltinType::UInt128: 5640 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3); 5641 } 5642 } 5643 5644 /// Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according 5645 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions). 5646 /// 5647 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no 5648 /// promotion occurs. 5649 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const { 5650 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent()) 5651 return {}; 5652 5653 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 5654 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 5655 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 5656 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 5657 return {}; 5658 5659 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This 5660 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various 5661 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator. 5662 5663 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields? 5664 if (!Field) 5665 return {}; 5666 5667 QualType FT = Field->getType(); 5668 5669 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this); 5670 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy); 5671 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 5672 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type 5673 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it 5674 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the 5675 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral 5676 // promotion applies to it. 5677 // C11 6.3.1.1/2: 5678 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:] 5679 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by 5680 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise, 5681 // it is converted to an unsigned int. 5682 // 5683 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int. 5684 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++. 5685 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of an enum bit-field whose rank is 5686 // greater than that of 'int'. We perform that promotion to match GCC. 5687 if (BitWidth < IntSize) 5688 return IntTy; 5689 5690 if (BitWidth == IntSize) 5691 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy; 5692 5693 // Bit-fields wider than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act 5694 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we 5695 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to 5696 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks 5697 // into their semantics in some cases). 5698 return {}; 5699 } 5700 5701 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will 5702 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable 5703 /// integer type. 5704 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const { 5705 assert(!Promotable.isNull()); 5706 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType()); 5707 if (const auto *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>()) 5708 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType(); 5709 5710 if (const auto *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5711 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t 5712 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following 5713 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type: 5714 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or 5715 // unsigned long long int [...] 5716 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this? 5717 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S || 5718 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U || 5719 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char8 || 5720 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 || 5721 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) { 5722 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S; 5723 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT); 5724 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy, 5725 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy }; 5726 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) { 5727 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 5728 if (FromSize < ToSize || 5729 (FromSize == ToSize && 5730 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) 5731 return PromoteTypes[Idx]; 5732 } 5733 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long"); 5734 } 5735 } 5736 5737 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type. 5738 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType()) 5739 return IntTy; 5740 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable); 5741 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy); 5742 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize); 5743 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy; 5744 } 5745 5746 /// Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable 5747 /// type and returns its ownership. 5748 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const { 5749 while (!T.isNull()) { 5750 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None) 5751 return T.getObjCLifetime(); 5752 if (T->isArrayType()) 5753 T = getBaseElementType(T); 5754 else if (const auto *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>()) 5755 T = PT->getPointeeType(); 5756 else if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 5757 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 5758 else 5759 break; 5760 } 5761 5762 return Qualifiers::OCL_None; 5763 } 5764 5765 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) { 5766 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types. 5767 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types. 5768 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped()) 5769 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr(); 5770 return nullptr; 5771 } 5772 5773 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type: 5774 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If 5775 /// LHS < RHS, return -1. 5776 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const { 5777 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr(); 5778 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr(); 5779 5780 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type. 5781 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC)) 5782 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET); 5783 if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC)) 5784 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET); 5785 5786 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0; 5787 5788 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 5789 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 5790 5791 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC); 5792 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC); 5793 5794 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned. 5795 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0; 5796 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1; 5797 } 5798 5799 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa. 5800 if (LHSUnsigned) { 5801 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it. 5802 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank) 5803 return 1; 5804 5805 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it 5806 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are 5807 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe. 5808 return -1; 5809 } 5810 5811 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it. 5812 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank) 5813 return -1; 5814 5815 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it 5816 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are 5817 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe. 5818 return 1; 5819 } 5820 5821 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const { 5822 if (CFConstantStringTypeDecl) 5823 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl; 5824 5825 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl && 5826 "tag and typedef should be initialized together"); 5827 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag"); 5828 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition(); 5829 5830 struct { 5831 QualType Type; 5832 const char *Name; 5833 } Fields[5]; 5834 unsigned Count = 0; 5835 5836 /// Objective-C ABI 5837 /// 5838 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag { 5839 /// const int *isa; 5840 /// int flags; 5841 /// const char *str; 5842 /// long length; 5843 /// } __NSConstantString; 5844 /// 5845 /// Swift ABI (4.1, 4.2) 5846 /// 5847 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag { 5848 /// uintptr_t _cfisa; 5849 /// uintptr_t _swift_rc; 5850 /// _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa; 5851 /// const char *_ptr; 5852 /// uint32_t _length; 5853 /// } __NSConstantString; 5854 /// 5855 /// Swift ABI (5.0) 5856 /// 5857 /// typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag { 5858 /// uintptr_t _cfisa; 5859 /// uintptr_t _swift_rc; 5860 /// _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa; 5861 /// const char *_ptr; 5862 /// uintptr_t _length; 5863 /// } __NSConstantString; 5864 5865 const auto CFRuntime = getLangOpts().CFRuntime; 5866 if (static_cast<unsigned>(CFRuntime) < 5867 static_cast<unsigned>(LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift)) { 5868 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(IntTy.withConst()), "isa" }; 5869 Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "flags" }; 5870 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "str" }; 5871 Fields[Count++] = { LongTy, "length" }; 5872 } else { 5873 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_cfisa" }; 5874 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_swift_rc" }; 5875 Fields[Count++] = { getFromTargetType(Target->getUInt64Type()), "_swift_rc" }; 5876 Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "_ptr" }; 5877 if (CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_1 || 5878 CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_2) 5879 Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "_ptr" }; 5880 else 5881 Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_ptr" }; 5882 } 5883 5884 // Create fields 5885 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Count; ++i) { 5886 FieldDecl *Field = 5887 FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl, SourceLocation(), 5888 SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Fields[i].Name), 5889 Fields[i].Type, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5890 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit); 5891 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 5892 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 5893 } 5894 5895 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 5896 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot 5897 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface. 5898 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl); 5899 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = 5900 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString"); 5901 5902 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl; 5903 } 5904 5905 RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const { 5906 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl) 5907 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef. 5908 return CFConstantStringTagDecl; 5909 } 5910 5911 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings. 5912 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const { 5913 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl()); 5914 } 5915 5916 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const { 5917 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) { 5918 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super"); 5919 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl); 5920 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl); 5921 } 5922 return ObjCSuperType; 5923 } 5924 5925 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) { 5926 const auto *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>(); 5927 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType"); 5928 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl()); 5929 const auto *TagType = 5930 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 5931 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType"); 5932 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl(); 5933 } 5934 5935 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const { 5936 if (BlockDescriptorType) 5937 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType); 5938 5939 RecordDecl *RD; 5940 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit. 5941 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor"); 5942 RD->startDefinition(); 5943 5944 QualType FieldTypes[] = { 5945 UnsignedLongTy, 5946 UnsignedLongTy, 5947 }; 5948 5949 static const char *const FieldNames[] = { 5950 "reserved", 5951 "Size" 5952 }; 5953 5954 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) { 5955 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create( 5956 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), 5957 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5958 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit); 5959 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 5960 RD->addDecl(Field); 5961 } 5962 5963 RD->completeDefinition(); 5964 5965 BlockDescriptorType = RD; 5966 5967 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType); 5968 } 5969 5970 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const { 5971 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType) 5972 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType); 5973 5974 RecordDecl *RD; 5975 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit. 5976 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose"); 5977 RD->startDefinition(); 5978 5979 QualType FieldTypes[] = { 5980 UnsignedLongTy, 5981 UnsignedLongTy, 5982 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy), 5983 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy) 5984 }; 5985 5986 static const char *const FieldNames[] = { 5987 "reserved", 5988 "Size", 5989 "CopyFuncPtr", 5990 "DestroyFuncPtr" 5991 }; 5992 5993 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) { 5994 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create( 5995 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), 5996 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5997 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 5998 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit); 5999 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 6000 RD->addDecl(Field); 6001 } 6002 6003 RD->completeDefinition(); 6004 6005 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD; 6006 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType); 6007 } 6008 6009 TargetInfo::OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const { 6010 const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T); 6011 6012 if (!BT) { 6013 if (isa<PipeType>(T)) 6014 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Pipe; 6015 6016 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default; 6017 } 6018 6019 switch (BT->getKind()) { 6020 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 6021 case BuiltinType::Id: \ 6022 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Image; 6023 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 6024 6025 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: 6026 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ClkEvent; 6027 6028 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: 6029 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Event; 6030 6031 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: 6032 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Queue; 6033 6034 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: 6035 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ReserveID; 6036 6037 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: 6038 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Sampler; 6039 6040 default: 6041 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default; 6042 } 6043 } 6044 6045 LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const { 6046 return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T)); 6047 } 6048 6049 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty" 6050 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic 6051 /// in buildByrefHelpers. 6052 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty, 6053 const VarDecl *D) { 6054 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 6055 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInit(D).getCopyExpr(); 6056 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false; 6057 6058 return true; 6059 } 6060 6061 // The block needs copy/destroy helpers if Ty is non-trivial to destructively 6062 // move or destroy. 6063 if (Ty.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructiveMove() || Ty.isDestructedType()) 6064 return true; 6065 6066 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false; 6067 6068 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers(); 6069 6070 // If we have lifetime, that dominates. 6071 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) { 6072 switch (lifetime) { 6073 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible"); 6074 6075 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned. 6076 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 6077 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 6078 return false; 6079 6080 // These cases should have been taken care of when checking the type's 6081 // non-triviality. 6082 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 6083 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 6084 llvm_unreachable("impossible"); 6085 } 6086 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!"); 6087 } 6088 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) || 6089 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 6090 } 6091 6092 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty, 6093 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime, 6094 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const { 6095 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC || 6096 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 6097 return false; 6098 6099 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false; 6100 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 6101 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true; 6102 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None; 6103 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) { 6104 // Honor the ARC qualifiers. 6105 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) { 6106 // The MRR rule. 6107 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 6108 } else { 6109 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None; 6110 } 6111 return true; 6112 } 6113 6114 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() { 6115 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl) 6116 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl = 6117 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype"); 6118 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl; 6119 } 6120 6121 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL: 6122 // typedef <type> BOOL; 6123 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) { 6124 if (const auto *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T)) 6125 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 6126 return II->isStr("BOOL"); 6127 6128 return false; 6129 } 6130 6131 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding 6132 /// purpose. 6133 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const { 6134 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType()) 6135 return CharUnits::Zero(); 6136 6137 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type); 6138 6139 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int 6140 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 6141 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy)); 6142 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in. 6143 else if (type->isArrayType()) 6144 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 6145 return sz; 6146 } 6147 6148 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const { 6149 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 6150 VD->isStaticDataMember() && 6151 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 6152 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit(); 6153 } 6154 6155 ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind 6156 ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const { 6157 if (!VD->isInline()) 6158 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None; 6159 6160 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition. 6161 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 6162 if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember()) 6163 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak; 6164 6165 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a 6166 // non-discardable definition. 6167 for (auto *D : VD->redecls()) 6168 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() && 6169 !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr())) 6170 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong; 6171 6172 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know. 6173 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown; 6174 } 6175 6176 static std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) { 6177 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity()); 6178 } 6179 6180 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block 6181 /// declaration. 6182 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const { 6183 std::string S; 6184 6185 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl(); 6186 QualType BlockTy = 6187 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6188 // Encode result type. 6189 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig) 6190 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter( 6191 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S, 6192 true /*Extended*/); 6193 else 6194 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S); 6195 // Compute size of all parameters. 6196 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes. 6197 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation! 6198 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 6199 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize; 6200 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) { 6201 QualType PType = PI->getType(); 6202 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6203 if (sz.isZero()) 6204 continue; 6205 assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type"); 6206 ParmOffset += sz; 6207 } 6208 // Size of the argument frame 6209 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6210 // Block pointer and offset. 6211 S += "@?0"; 6212 6213 // Argument types. 6214 ParmOffset = PtrSize; 6215 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) { 6216 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 6217 if (const auto *AT = 6218 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 6219 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 6220 // elements. 6221 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 6222 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6223 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 6224 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6225 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig) 6226 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType, 6227 S, true /*Extended*/); 6228 else 6229 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S); 6230 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6231 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6232 } 6233 6234 return S; 6235 } 6236 6237 std::string 6238 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const { 6239 std::string S; 6240 // Encode result type. 6241 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S); 6242 CharUnits ParmOffset; 6243 // Compute size of all parameters. 6244 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) { 6245 QualType PType = PI->getType(); 6246 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6247 if (sz.isZero()) 6248 continue; 6249 6250 assert(sz.isPositive() && 6251 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type"); 6252 ParmOffset += sz; 6253 } 6254 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6255 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero(); 6256 6257 // Argument types. 6258 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) { 6259 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 6260 if (const auto *AT = 6261 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 6262 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 6263 // elements. 6264 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 6265 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6266 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 6267 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6268 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S); 6269 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6270 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6271 } 6272 6273 return S; 6274 } 6275 6276 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single 6277 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and 6278 /// block object types. 6279 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT, 6280 QualType T, std::string& S, 6281 bool Extended) const { 6282 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter. 6283 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S); 6284 // Encode parameter type. 6285 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr, 6286 true /*OutermostType*/, 6287 false /*EncodingProperty*/, 6288 false /*StructField*/, 6289 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/, 6290 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/); 6291 } 6292 6293 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method 6294 /// declaration. 6295 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl, 6296 bool Extended) const { 6297 // FIXME: This is not very efficient. 6298 // Encode return type. 6299 std::string S; 6300 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(), 6301 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended); 6302 // Compute size of all parameters. 6303 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes. 6304 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation! 6305 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy); 6306 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for 6307 // their size. 6308 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize; 6309 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), 6310 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) { 6311 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType(); 6312 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6313 if (sz.isZero()) 6314 continue; 6315 6316 assert(sz.isPositive() && 6317 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type"); 6318 ParmOffset += sz; 6319 } 6320 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6321 S += "@0:"; 6322 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize); 6323 6324 // Argument types. 6325 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize; 6326 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), 6327 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) { 6328 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI; 6329 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType(); 6330 if (const auto *AT = 6331 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) { 6332 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of 6333 // elements. 6334 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 6335 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6336 } else if (PType->isFunctionType()) 6337 PType = PVDecl->getType(); 6338 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(), 6339 PType, S, Extended); 6340 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset); 6341 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType); 6342 } 6343 6344 return S; 6345 } 6346 6347 ObjCPropertyImplDecl * 6348 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl( 6349 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD, 6350 const Decl *Container) const { 6351 if (!Container) 6352 return nullptr; 6353 if (const auto *CID = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) { 6354 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls()) 6355 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) 6356 return PID; 6357 } else { 6358 const auto *OID = cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container); 6359 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls()) 6360 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) 6361 return PID; 6362 } 6363 return nullptr; 6364 } 6365 6366 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this 6367 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an 6368 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be 6369 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties. 6370 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple 6371 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The 6372 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are 6373 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types 6374 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode 6375 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration: 6376 /// @code 6377 /// enum PropertyAttributes { 6378 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only. 6379 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned 6380 /// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned 6381 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic 6382 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name 6383 /// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name 6384 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name 6385 /// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding. 6386 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property 6387 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able 6388 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic 6389 /// }; 6390 /// @endcode 6391 std::string 6392 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD, 6393 const Decl *Container) const { 6394 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s). 6395 bool Dynamic = false; 6396 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr; 6397 6398 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl = 6399 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) { 6400 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) 6401 Dynamic = true; 6402 else 6403 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl; 6404 } 6405 6406 // FIXME: This is not very efficient. 6407 std::string S = "T"; 6408 6409 // Encode result type. 6410 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which 6411 // closely resembles encoding of ivars. 6412 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S); 6413 6414 if (PD->isReadOnly()) { 6415 S += ",R"; 6416 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy) 6417 S += ",C"; 6418 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain) 6419 S += ",&"; 6420 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak) 6421 S += ",W"; 6422 } else { 6423 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) { 6424 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break; 6425 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break; 6426 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break; 6427 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break; 6428 } 6429 } 6430 6431 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties 6432 // are "dynamic by default". 6433 if (Dynamic) 6434 S += ",D"; 6435 6436 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic) 6437 S += ",N"; 6438 6439 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) { 6440 S += ",G"; 6441 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString(); 6442 } 6443 6444 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) { 6445 S += ",S"; 6446 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString(); 6447 } 6448 6449 if (SynthesizePID) { 6450 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl(); 6451 S += ",V"; 6452 S += OID->getNameAsString(); 6453 } 6454 6455 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong 6456 return S; 6457 } 6458 6459 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding - 6460 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as 6461 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use 6462 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer! 6463 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const { 6464 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) { 6465 if (const auto *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 6466 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32) 6467 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy; 6468 else 6469 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32) 6470 PointeeTy = IntTy; 6471 } 6472 } 6473 } 6474 6475 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S, 6476 const FieldDecl *Field, 6477 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 6478 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are 6479 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that 6480 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the 6481 // same type. 6482 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field, 6483 true /* outermost type */, false, false, 6484 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 6485 } 6486 6487 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T, 6488 std::string& S) const { 6489 // Encode result type. 6490 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which 6491 // closely resembles encoding of ivars. 6492 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr, 6493 true /* outermost type */, 6494 true /* encoding property */); 6495 } 6496 6497 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C, 6498 BuiltinType::Kind kind) { 6499 switch (kind) { 6500 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v'; 6501 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B'; 6502 case BuiltinType::Char8: 6503 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 6504 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C'; 6505 case BuiltinType::Char16: 6506 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S'; 6507 case BuiltinType::Char32: 6508 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I'; 6509 case BuiltinType::ULong: 6510 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q'; 6511 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T'; 6512 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q'; 6513 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 6514 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c'; 6515 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's'; 6516 case BuiltinType::WChar_S: 6517 case BuiltinType::WChar_U: 6518 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i'; 6519 case BuiltinType::Long: 6520 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q'; 6521 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q'; 6522 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't'; 6523 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f'; 6524 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd'; 6525 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D'; 6526 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char* 6527 6528 case BuiltinType::Float16: 6529 case BuiltinType::Float128: 6530 case BuiltinType::Half: 6531 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 6532 case BuiltinType::Accum: 6533 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 6534 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 6535 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 6536 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 6537 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 6538 case BuiltinType::Fract: 6539 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 6540 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 6541 case BuiltinType::UFract: 6542 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 6543 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 6544 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 6545 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 6546 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 6547 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 6548 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 6549 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 6550 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 6551 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 6552 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 6553 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 6554 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 6555 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these! 6556 return ' '; 6557 6558 case BuiltinType::ObjCId: 6559 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass: 6560 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel: 6561 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type"); 6562 6563 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings. 6564 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 6565 case BuiltinType::Id: 6566 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 6567 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 6568 case BuiltinType::Id: 6569 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 6570 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: 6571 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: 6572 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: 6573 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: 6574 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: 6575 case BuiltinType::Dependent: 6576 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID) 6577 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \ 6578 case BuiltinType::KIND: 6579 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 6580 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode"); 6581 } 6582 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value"); 6583 } 6584 6585 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) { 6586 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl(); 6587 6588 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size. 6589 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 6590 return 'i'; 6591 6592 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type. 6593 const auto *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>(); 6594 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind()); 6595 } 6596 6597 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S, 6598 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) { 6599 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl"); 6600 S += 'b'; 6601 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits. 6602 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b, 6603 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the 6604 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure: 6605 // 6606 // struct 6607 // { 6608 // int integer; 6609 // int flags:2; 6610 // }; 6611 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT 6612 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra 6613 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for 6614 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that 6615 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes... 6616 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) { 6617 uint64_t Offset; 6618 6619 if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) { 6620 Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr, 6621 IVD); 6622 } else { 6623 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent(); 6624 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6625 Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()); 6626 } 6627 6628 S += llvm::utostr(Offset); 6629 6630 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 6631 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET); 6632 else { 6633 const auto *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>(); 6634 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind()); 6635 } 6636 } 6637 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx)); 6638 } 6639 6640 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string. 6641 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S, 6642 bool ExpandPointedToStructures, 6643 bool ExpandStructures, 6644 const FieldDecl *FD, 6645 bool OutermostType, 6646 bool EncodingProperty, 6647 bool StructField, 6648 bool EncodeBlockParameters, 6649 bool EncodeClassNames, 6650 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef, 6651 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 6652 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T); 6653 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) { 6654 case Type::Builtin: 6655 case Type::Enum: 6656 if (FD && FD->isBitField()) 6657 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD); 6658 if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT)) 6659 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind()); 6660 else 6661 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT)); 6662 return; 6663 6664 case Type::Complex: { 6665 const auto *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>(); 6666 S += 'j'; 6667 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr); 6668 return; 6669 } 6670 6671 case Type::Atomic: { 6672 const auto *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>(); 6673 S += 'A'; 6674 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr); 6675 return; 6676 } 6677 6678 // encoding for pointer or reference types. 6679 case Type::Pointer: 6680 case Type::LValueReference: 6681 case Type::RValueReference: { 6682 QualType PointeeTy; 6683 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) { 6684 const auto *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>(); 6685 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) { 6686 S += ':'; 6687 return; 6688 } 6689 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType(); 6690 } else { 6691 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 6692 } 6693 6694 bool isReadOnly = false; 6695 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the 6696 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of 6697 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef! 6698 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type! 6699 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) { 6700 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) { 6701 isReadOnly = true; 6702 S += 'r'; 6703 } 6704 } else if (OutermostType) { 6705 QualType P = PointeeTy; 6706 while (P->getAs<PointerType>()) 6707 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6708 if (P.isConstQualified()) { 6709 isReadOnly = true; 6710 S += 'r'; 6711 } 6712 } 6713 if (isReadOnly) { 6714 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type 6715 // combinations need to be rearranged. 6716 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn" 6717 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr")) 6718 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn"); 6719 } 6720 6721 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) { 6722 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a 6723 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'. 6724 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) { 6725 S += '*'; 6726 return; 6727 } 6728 } else if (const auto *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 6729 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#". 6730 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) { 6731 S += '#'; 6732 return; 6733 } 6734 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@". 6735 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) { 6736 S += '@'; 6737 return; 6738 } 6739 // fall through... 6740 } 6741 S += '^'; 6742 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy); 6743 6744 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures, 6745 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false, 6746 NotEncodedT); 6747 return; 6748 } 6749 6750 case Type::ConstantArray: 6751 case Type::IncompleteArray: 6752 case Type::VariableArray: { 6753 const auto *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT); 6754 6755 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) { 6756 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element. 6757 S += '^'; 6758 6759 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S, 6760 false, ExpandStructures, FD); 6761 } else { 6762 S += '['; 6763 6764 if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 6765 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue()); 6766 else { 6767 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements. 6768 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) && 6769 "Unknown array type!"); 6770 S += '0'; 6771 } 6772 6773 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S, 6774 false, ExpandStructures, FD, 6775 false, false, false, false, false, false, 6776 NotEncodedT); 6777 S += ']'; 6778 } 6779 return; 6780 } 6781 6782 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 6783 case Type::FunctionProto: 6784 S += '?'; 6785 return; 6786 6787 case Type::Record: { 6788 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl(); 6789 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{'; 6790 // Anonymous structures print as '?' 6791 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) { 6792 S += II->getName(); 6793 if (const auto *Spec = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) { 6794 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs(); 6795 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S); 6796 printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(), 6797 getPrintingPolicy()); 6798 } 6799 } else { 6800 S += '?'; 6801 } 6802 if (ExpandStructures) { 6803 S += '='; 6804 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) { 6805 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT); 6806 } else { 6807 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) { 6808 if (FD) { 6809 S += '"'; 6810 S += Field->getNameAsString(); 6811 S += '"'; 6812 } 6813 6814 // Special case bit-fields. 6815 if (Field->isBitField()) { 6816 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, 6817 Field); 6818 } else { 6819 QualType qt = Field->getType(); 6820 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt); 6821 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, 6822 FD, /*OutermostType*/false, 6823 /*EncodingProperty*/false, 6824 /*StructField*/true, 6825 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 6826 } 6827 } 6828 } 6829 } 6830 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}'; 6831 return; 6832 } 6833 6834 case Type::BlockPointer: { 6835 const auto *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>(); 6836 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?". 6837 if (EncodeBlockParameters) { 6838 const auto *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 6839 6840 S += '<'; 6841 // Block return type 6842 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl( 6843 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, 6844 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty, 6845 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false, 6846 NotEncodedT); 6847 // Block self 6848 S += "@?"; 6849 // Block parameters 6850 if (const auto *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) { 6851 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types()) 6852 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl( 6853 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD, 6854 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty, 6855 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, 6856 false, NotEncodedT); 6857 } 6858 S += '>'; 6859 } 6860 return; 6861 } 6862 6863 case Type::ObjCObject: { 6864 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class 6865 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT); 6866 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) { 6867 S += "{objc_object=}"; 6868 return; 6869 } 6870 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) { 6871 S += "{objc_class=}"; 6872 return; 6873 } 6874 // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentionally falls through. 6875 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6876 } 6877 6878 case Type::ObjCInterface: { 6879 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level. 6880 // @encode(class_name) 6881 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface(); 6882 S += '{'; 6883 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 6884 if (ExpandStructures) { 6885 S += '='; 6886 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars; 6887 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars); 6888 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) { 6889 const FieldDecl *Field = Ivars[i]; 6890 if (Field->isBitField()) 6891 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field); 6892 else 6893 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD, 6894 false, false, false, false, false, 6895 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef, 6896 NotEncodedT); 6897 } 6898 } 6899 S += '}'; 6900 return; 6901 } 6902 6903 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: { 6904 const auto *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 6905 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) { 6906 S += '@'; 6907 return; 6908 } 6909 6910 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) { 6911 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'. 6912 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime 6913 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obscure construct. 6914 S += '#'; 6915 return; 6916 } 6917 6918 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 6919 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S, 6920 ExpandPointedToStructures, 6921 ExpandStructures, FD); 6922 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) { 6923 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list 6924 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding. 6925 S += '"'; 6926 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) { 6927 S += '<'; 6928 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 6929 S += '>'; 6930 } 6931 S += '"'; 6932 } 6933 return; 6934 } 6935 6936 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType(); 6937 if (!EncodingProperty && 6938 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) && 6939 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) { 6940 // Another historical/compatibility reason. 6941 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as 6942 // {...}; 6943 S += '^'; 6944 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 6945 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases. 6946 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl(); 6947 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars; 6948 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars); 6949 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) { 6950 if (Ivars[i] == FD) { 6951 S += '{'; 6952 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 6953 S += '}'; 6954 return; 6955 } 6956 } 6957 } 6958 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, 6959 false, ExpandPointedToStructures, 6960 nullptr, 6961 false, false, false, false, false, 6962 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true); 6963 return; 6964 } 6965 6966 S += '@'; 6967 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() && 6968 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) { 6969 S += '"'; 6970 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 6971 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) { 6972 S += '<'; 6973 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString(); 6974 S += '>'; 6975 } 6976 S += '"'; 6977 } 6978 return; 6979 } 6980 6981 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers. 6982 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available. 6983 case Type::MemberPointer: 6984 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient. 6985 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc. 6986 case Type::Vector: 6987 case Type::ExtVector: 6988 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning. 6989 if (NotEncodedT) 6990 *NotEncodedT = T; 6991 return; 6992 6993 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery. 6994 // Just ignore it. 6995 case Type::Auto: 6996 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 6997 return; 6998 6999 case Type::Pipe: 7000 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) 7001 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE) 7002 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 7003 case Type::KIND: 7004 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 7005 case Type::KIND: 7006 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \ 7007 case Type::KIND: 7008 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 7009 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!"); 7010 } 7011 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!"); 7012 } 7013 7014 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl, 7015 std::string &S, 7016 const FieldDecl *FD, 7017 bool includeVBases, 7018 QualType *NotEncodedT) const { 7019 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl"); 7020 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions"); 7021 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl()) 7022 return; 7023 7024 const auto *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl); 7025 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets; 7026 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl); 7027 7028 if (CXXRec) { 7029 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) { 7030 if (!BI.isVirtual()) { 7031 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 7032 if (base->isEmpty()) 7033 continue; 7034 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base)); 7035 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 7036 std::make_pair(offs, base)); 7037 } 7038 } 7039 } 7040 7041 unsigned i = 0; 7042 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) { 7043 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i); 7044 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 7045 std::make_pair(offs, Field)); 7046 ++i; 7047 } 7048 7049 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) { 7050 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) { 7051 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 7052 if (base->isEmpty()) 7053 continue; 7054 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base)); 7055 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) && 7056 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end()) 7057 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(), 7058 std::make_pair(offs, base)); 7059 } 7060 } 7061 7062 CharUnits size; 7063 if (CXXRec) { 7064 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize(); 7065 } else { 7066 size = layout.getSize(); 7067 } 7068 7069 #ifndef NDEBUG 7070 uint64_t CurOffs = 0; 7071 #endif 7072 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator 7073 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin(); 7074 7075 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() && 7076 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) { 7077 if (FD) { 7078 S += "\"_vptr$"; 7079 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString(); 7080 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?"; 7081 S += recname; 7082 S += '"'; 7083 } 7084 S += "^^?"; 7085 #ifndef NDEBUG 7086 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy); 7087 #endif 7088 } 7089 7090 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 7091 // Mark the end of the structure. 7092 uint64_t offs = toBits(size); 7093 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs), 7094 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr)); 7095 } 7096 7097 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) { 7098 #ifndef NDEBUG 7099 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first); 7100 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) { 7101 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs; 7102 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that 7103 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case 7104 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout. 7105 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without 7106 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the 7107 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be 7108 // longer then though. 7109 CurOffs += padding; 7110 } 7111 #endif 7112 7113 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second; 7114 if (!dcl) 7115 break; // reached end of structure. 7116 7117 if (auto *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) { 7118 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going 7119 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which 7120 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy, 7121 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is. 7122 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false, 7123 NotEncodedT); 7124 assert(!base->isEmpty()); 7125 #ifndef NDEBUG 7126 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize()); 7127 #endif 7128 } else { 7129 const auto *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl); 7130 if (FD) { 7131 S += '"'; 7132 S += field->getNameAsString(); 7133 S += '"'; 7134 } 7135 7136 if (field->isBitField()) { 7137 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field); 7138 #ifndef NDEBUG 7139 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this); 7140 #endif 7141 } else { 7142 QualType qt = field->getType(); 7143 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt); 7144 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD, 7145 /*OutermostType*/false, 7146 /*EncodingProperty*/false, 7147 /*StructField*/true, 7148 false, false, false, NotEncodedT); 7149 #ifndef NDEBUG 7150 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType()); 7151 #endif 7152 } 7153 } 7154 } 7155 } 7156 7157 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT, 7158 std::string& S) const { 7159 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In) 7160 S += 'n'; 7161 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout) 7162 S += 'N'; 7163 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out) 7164 S += 'o'; 7165 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy) 7166 S += 'O'; 7167 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref) 7168 S += 'R'; 7169 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway) 7170 S += 'V'; 7171 } 7172 7173 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const { 7174 if (!ObjCIdDecl) { 7175 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {}); 7176 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 7177 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id"); 7178 } 7179 return ObjCIdDecl; 7180 } 7181 7182 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const { 7183 if (!ObjCSelDecl) { 7184 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy); 7185 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL"); 7186 } 7187 return ObjCSelDecl; 7188 } 7189 7190 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const { 7191 if (!ObjCClassDecl) { 7192 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {}); 7193 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 7194 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class"); 7195 } 7196 return ObjCClassDecl; 7197 } 7198 7199 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const { 7200 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) { 7201 ObjCProtocolClassDecl 7202 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(), 7203 SourceLocation(), 7204 &Idents.get("Protocol"), 7205 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr, 7206 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 7207 SourceLocation(), true); 7208 } 7209 7210 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl; 7211 } 7212 7213 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7214 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions 7215 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7216 7217 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context, 7218 StringRef Name) { 7219 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list; 7220 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy); 7221 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name); 7222 } 7223 7224 static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7225 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list"); 7226 } 7227 7228 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7229 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list"); 7230 } 7231 7232 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7233 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list; 7234 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7235 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list"); 7236 } 7237 7238 static TypedefDecl * 7239 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7240 // struct __va_list 7241 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list"); 7242 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7243 // namespace std { struct __va_list { 7244 NamespaceDecl *NS; 7245 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7246 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(), 7247 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(), 7248 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"), 7249 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr); 7250 NS->setImplicit(); 7251 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS); 7252 } 7253 7254 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 7255 7256 const size_t NumFields = 5; 7257 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 7258 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 7259 7260 // void *__stack; 7261 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7262 FieldNames[0] = "__stack"; 7263 7264 // void *__gr_top; 7265 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7266 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top"; 7267 7268 // void *__vr_top; 7269 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7270 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top"; 7271 7272 // int __gr_offs; 7273 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy; 7274 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs"; 7275 7276 // int __vr_offs; 7277 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy; 7278 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs"; 7279 7280 // Create fields 7281 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 7282 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7283 VaListTagDecl, 7284 SourceLocation(), 7285 SourceLocation(), 7286 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 7287 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 7288 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 7289 /*Mutable=*/false, 7290 ICIS_NoInit); 7291 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 7292 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 7293 } 7294 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 7295 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 7296 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 7297 7298 // } __builtin_va_list; 7299 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list"); 7300 } 7301 7302 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7303 // typedef struct __va_list_tag { 7304 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 7305 7306 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 7307 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 7308 7309 const size_t NumFields = 5; 7310 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 7311 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 7312 7313 // unsigned char gpr; 7314 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy; 7315 FieldNames[0] = "gpr"; 7316 7317 // unsigned char fpr; 7318 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy; 7319 FieldNames[1] = "fpr"; 7320 7321 // unsigned short reserved; 7322 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy; 7323 FieldNames[2] = "reserved"; 7324 7325 // void* overflow_arg_area; 7326 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7327 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area"; 7328 7329 // void* reg_save_area; 7330 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7331 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area"; 7332 7333 // Create fields 7334 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 7335 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl, 7336 SourceLocation(), 7337 SourceLocation(), 7338 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 7339 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 7340 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 7341 /*Mutable=*/false, 7342 ICIS_NoInit); 7343 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 7344 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 7345 } 7346 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 7347 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 7348 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 7349 7350 // } __va_list_tag; 7351 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl = 7352 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag"); 7353 7354 QualType VaListTagTypedefType = 7355 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl); 7356 7357 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 7358 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 7359 QualType VaListTagArrayType 7360 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType, 7361 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 7362 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 7363 } 7364 7365 static TypedefDecl * 7366 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7367 // struct __va_list_tag { 7368 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 7369 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 7370 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 7371 7372 const size_t NumFields = 4; 7373 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 7374 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 7375 7376 // unsigned gp_offset; 7377 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy; 7378 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset"; 7379 7380 // unsigned fp_offset; 7381 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy; 7382 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset"; 7383 7384 // void* overflow_arg_area; 7385 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7386 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area"; 7387 7388 // void* reg_save_area; 7389 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7390 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area"; 7391 7392 // Create fields 7393 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 7394 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7395 VaListTagDecl, 7396 SourceLocation(), 7397 SourceLocation(), 7398 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 7399 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 7400 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 7401 /*Mutable=*/false, 7402 ICIS_NoInit); 7403 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 7404 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 7405 } 7406 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 7407 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 7408 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 7409 7410 // }; 7411 7412 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 7413 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 7414 QualType VaListTagArrayType = 7415 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 7416 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 7417 } 7418 7419 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7420 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4]; 7421 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4); 7422 QualType IntArrayType = 7423 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 7424 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 7425 } 7426 7427 static TypedefDecl * 7428 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7429 // struct __va_list 7430 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list"); 7431 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7432 // namespace std { struct __va_list { 7433 NamespaceDecl *NS; 7434 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7435 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(), 7436 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(), 7437 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"), 7438 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr); 7439 NS->setImplicit(); 7440 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS); 7441 } 7442 7443 VaListDecl->startDefinition(); 7444 7445 // void * __ap; 7446 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7447 VaListDecl, 7448 SourceLocation(), 7449 SourceLocation(), 7450 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"), 7451 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy), 7452 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 7453 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 7454 /*Mutable=*/false, 7455 ICIS_NoInit); 7456 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 7457 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field); 7458 7459 // }; 7460 VaListDecl->completeDefinition(); 7461 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl; 7462 7463 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list; 7464 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl); 7465 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list"); 7466 } 7467 7468 static TypedefDecl * 7469 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) { 7470 // struct __va_list_tag { 7471 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl; 7472 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag"); 7473 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition(); 7474 7475 const size_t NumFields = 4; 7476 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields]; 7477 const char *FieldNames[NumFields]; 7478 7479 // long __gpr; 7480 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy; 7481 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr"; 7482 7483 // long __fpr; 7484 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy; 7485 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr"; 7486 7487 // void *__overflow_arg_area; 7488 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7489 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area"; 7490 7491 // void *__reg_save_area; 7492 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy); 7493 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area"; 7494 7495 // Create fields 7496 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) { 7497 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), 7498 VaListTagDecl, 7499 SourceLocation(), 7500 SourceLocation(), 7501 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), 7502 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 7503 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, 7504 /*Mutable=*/false, 7505 ICIS_NoInit); 7506 Field->setAccess(AS_public); 7507 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field); 7508 } 7509 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition(); 7510 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl; 7511 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl); 7512 7513 // }; 7514 7515 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1]; 7516 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1); 7517 QualType VaListTagArrayType = 7518 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 7519 7520 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list"); 7521 } 7522 7523 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context, 7524 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) { 7525 switch (Kind) { 7526 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList: 7527 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7528 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList: 7529 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7530 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList: 7531 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7532 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList: 7533 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7534 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList: 7535 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7536 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList: 7537 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7538 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList: 7539 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7540 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList: 7541 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context); 7542 } 7543 7544 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind"); 7545 } 7546 7547 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const { 7548 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) { 7549 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind()); 7550 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit()); 7551 } 7552 7553 return BuiltinVaListDecl; 7554 } 7555 7556 Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const { 7557 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list 7558 // declaration. 7559 if (!VaListTagDecl) 7560 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl(); 7561 7562 return VaListTagDecl; 7563 } 7564 7565 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const { 7566 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl) 7567 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this); 7568 7569 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl; 7570 } 7571 7572 bool ASTContext::canBuiltinBeRedeclared(const FunctionDecl *FD) const { 7573 return BuiltinInfo.canBeRedeclared(FD->getBuiltinID()); 7574 } 7575 7576 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) { 7577 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() && 7578 "'NSConstantString' type already set!"); 7579 7580 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl); 7581 } 7582 7583 /// Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty 7584 /// lookup. 7585 TemplateName 7586 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin, 7587 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const { 7588 unsigned size = End - Begin; 7589 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!"); 7590 7591 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) + 7592 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*)); 7593 auto *OT = new (memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size); 7594 7595 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage(); 7596 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) { 7597 NamedDecl *D = *I; 7598 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) || 7599 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D) || 7600 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) && 7601 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl()))); 7602 *Storage++ = D; 7603 } 7604 7605 return TemplateName(OT); 7606 } 7607 7608 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified 7609 /// template name such as \c std::vector. 7610 TemplateName 7611 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 7612 bool TemplateKeyword, 7613 TemplateDecl *Template) const { 7614 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name"); 7615 7616 // FIXME: Canonicalization? 7617 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 7618 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template); 7619 7620 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 7621 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = 7622 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7623 if (!QTN) { 7624 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName)) 7625 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template); 7626 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 7627 } 7628 7629 return TemplateName(QTN); 7630 } 7631 7632 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent 7633 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply. 7634 TemplateName 7635 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 7636 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const { 7637 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 7638 "Nested name specifier must be dependent"); 7639 7640 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 7641 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name); 7642 7643 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 7644 DependentTemplateName *QTN = 7645 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7646 7647 if (QTN) 7648 return TemplateName(QTN); 7649 7650 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 7651 if (CanonNNS == NNS) { 7652 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName)) 7653 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name); 7654 } else { 7655 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name); 7656 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName)) 7657 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon); 7658 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN = 7659 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7660 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken"); 7661 (void)CheckQTN; 7662 } 7663 7664 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 7665 return TemplateName(QTN); 7666 } 7667 7668 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent 7669 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+. 7670 TemplateName 7671 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, 7672 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const { 7673 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) && 7674 "Nested name specifier must be dependent"); 7675 7676 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 7677 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator); 7678 7679 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 7680 DependentTemplateName *QTN 7681 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7682 7683 if (QTN) 7684 return TemplateName(QTN); 7685 7686 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS); 7687 if (CanonNNS == NNS) { 7688 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName)) 7689 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator); 7690 } else { 7691 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator); 7692 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName)) 7693 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon); 7694 7695 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN 7696 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7697 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken"); 7698 (void)CheckQTN; 7699 } 7700 7701 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos); 7702 return TemplateName(QTN); 7703 } 7704 7705 TemplateName 7706 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param, 7707 TemplateName replacement) const { 7708 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 7709 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement); 7710 7711 void *insertPos = nullptr; 7712 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst 7713 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos); 7714 7715 if (!subst) { 7716 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement); 7717 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos); 7718 } 7719 7720 return TemplateName(subst); 7721 } 7722 7723 TemplateName 7724 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param, 7725 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const { 7726 auto &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this); 7727 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID; 7728 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack); 7729 7730 void *InsertPos = nullptr; 7731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst 7732 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos); 7733 7734 if (!Subst) { 7735 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param, 7736 ArgPack.pack_size(), 7737 ArgPack.pack_begin()); 7738 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos); 7739 } 7740 7741 return TemplateName(Subst); 7742 } 7743 7744 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by 7745 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type 7746 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType. 7747 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const { 7748 switch (Type) { 7749 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return {}; 7750 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy; 7751 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy; 7752 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy; 7753 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy; 7754 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy; 7755 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy; 7756 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy; 7757 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy; 7758 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy; 7759 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy; 7760 } 7761 7762 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value"); 7763 } 7764 7765 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7766 // Type Predicates. 7767 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7768 7769 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's 7770 /// garbage collection attribute. 7771 /// 7772 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const { 7773 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC) 7774 return Qualifiers::GCNone; 7775 7776 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC); 7777 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr(); 7778 7779 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers 7780 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared 7781 // as __strong. 7782 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) { 7783 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 7784 return Qualifiers::Strong; 7785 else if (Ty->isPointerType()) 7786 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 7787 } else { 7788 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a 7789 // pointer. 7790 #ifndef NDEBUG 7791 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal(); 7792 while (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT)) 7793 CT = AT->getElementType(); 7794 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType()); 7795 #endif 7796 } 7797 return GCAttrs; 7798 } 7799 7800 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7801 // Type Compatibility Testing 7802 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7803 7804 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are 7805 /// compatible. 7806 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS, 7807 const VectorType *RHS) { 7808 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified()); 7809 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() && 7810 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements(); 7811 } 7812 7813 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec, 7814 QualType SecondVec) { 7815 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type"); 7816 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type"); 7817 7818 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec)) 7819 return true; 7820 7821 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the 7822 // equivalent GCC vector types. 7823 const auto *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>(); 7824 const auto *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>(); 7825 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() && 7826 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) && 7827 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel && 7828 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool && 7829 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel && 7830 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool) 7831 return true; 7832 7833 return false; 7834 } 7835 7836 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7837 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's. 7838 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7839 7840 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the 7841 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'. 7842 bool 7843 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto, 7844 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const { 7845 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto)) 7846 return true; 7847 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols()) 7848 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI)) 7849 return true; 7850 return false; 7851 } 7852 7853 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and 7854 /// Class<pr1, ...>. 7855 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, 7856 QualType rhs) { 7857 const auto *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7858 const auto *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7859 assert((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible"); 7860 7861 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) { 7862 bool match = false; 7863 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) { 7864 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) { 7865 match = true; 7866 break; 7867 } 7868 } 7869 if (!match) 7870 return false; 7871 } 7872 return true; 7873 } 7874 7875 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an 7876 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType. 7877 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 7878 bool compare) { 7879 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases. 7880 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() || 7881 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType()) 7882 return true; 7883 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() || 7884 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType()) 7885 return true; 7886 7887 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 7888 const auto *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7889 7890 if (!rhsOPT) return false; 7891 7892 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) { 7893 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*", 7894 // make sure we check the class hierarchy. 7895 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 7896 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) { 7897 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 7898 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 7899 // through its super class and categories. 7900 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) 7901 return false; 7902 } 7903 } 7904 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'. 7905 return true; 7906 } 7907 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 7908 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) { 7909 bool match = false; 7910 7911 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 7912 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 7913 // through its super class and categories. 7914 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) { 7915 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 7916 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 7917 match = true; 7918 break; 7919 } 7920 } 7921 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*", 7922 // make sure we check the class hierarchy. 7923 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 7924 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) { 7925 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs, 7926 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 7927 // through its super class and categories. 7928 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) { 7929 match = true; 7930 break; 7931 } 7932 } 7933 } 7934 if (!match) 7935 return false; 7936 } 7937 7938 return true; 7939 } 7940 7941 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType(); 7942 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>"); 7943 7944 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = 7945 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) { 7946 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers. 7947 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) { 7948 bool match = false; 7949 7950 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs, 7951 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or 7952 // through its super class and categories. 7953 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct 7954 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch. 7955 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) { 7956 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 7957 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 7958 match = true; 7959 break; 7960 } 7961 } 7962 if (!match) 7963 return false; 7964 } 7965 7966 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols 7967 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch. 7968 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) { 7969 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols; 7970 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols); 7971 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has 7972 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s) 7973 // assume that it is mismatch. 7974 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty()) 7975 return false; 7976 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) { 7977 bool match = false; 7978 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) { 7979 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) || 7980 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) { 7981 match = true; 7982 break; 7983 } 7984 } 7985 if (!match) 7986 return false; 7987 } 7988 } 7989 return true; 7990 } 7991 return false; 7992 } 7993 7994 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are 7995 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any 7996 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS. 7997 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 7998 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) { 7999 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType(); 8000 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType(); 8001 8002 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true. 8003 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() || 8004 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass()) 8005 return true; 8006 8007 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles 8008 // __kindof types. 8009 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool { 8010 if (succeeded) 8011 return true; 8012 8013 if (!RHS->isKindOfType()) 8014 return false; 8015 8016 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether 8017 // we can assign the other way. 8018 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 8019 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this)); 8020 }; 8021 8022 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) { 8023 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 8024 QualType(RHSOPT,0), 8025 false)); 8026 } 8027 8028 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) { 8029 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 8030 QualType(RHSOPT,0))); 8031 } 8032 8033 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path. 8034 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) { 8035 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)); 8036 } 8037 8038 return false; 8039 } 8040 8041 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written 8042 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return 8043 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where 8044 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is 8045 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK. 8046 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 8047 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 8048 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT, 8049 bool BlockReturnType) { 8050 8051 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles 8052 // __kindof types. 8053 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool { 8054 if (succeeded) 8055 return true; 8056 8057 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT; 8058 if (!Expected->isKindOfType()) 8059 return false; 8060 8061 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether 8062 // we can assign the other way. 8063 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 8064 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 8065 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this), 8066 BlockReturnType); 8067 }; 8068 8069 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType()) 8070 return true; 8071 8072 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 8073 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || 8074 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()); 8075 } 8076 8077 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 8078 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0), 8079 QualType(RHSOPT,0), 8080 false)); 8081 8082 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType(); 8083 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType(); 8084 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types. 8085 if (LHS != RHS) { 8086 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl())) 8087 return finish(BlockReturnType); 8088 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl())) 8089 return finish(!BlockReturnType); 8090 } 8091 else 8092 return true; 8093 } 8094 return false; 8095 } 8096 8097 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with 8098 /// llvm::array_pod_sort. 8099 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs, 8100 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) { 8101 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName()); 8102 } 8103 8104 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set 8105 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with 8106 /// the given common base. 8107 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of 8108 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects. 8109 static 8110 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context, 8111 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase, 8112 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT, 8113 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT, 8114 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) { 8115 8116 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType(); 8117 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType(); 8118 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base"); 8119 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base"); 8120 8121 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS. 8122 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet; 8123 8124 // Start with the protocol qualifiers. 8125 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) { 8126 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet); 8127 } 8128 8129 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface. 8130 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet); 8131 8132 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS. 8133 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet; 8134 8135 // Start with the protocol qualifiers. 8136 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) { 8137 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet); 8138 } 8139 8140 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface. 8141 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet); 8142 8143 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets. 8144 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) { 8145 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto)) 8146 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto); 8147 } 8148 8149 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or 8150 // the protocols within the intersection. 8151 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols; 8152 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols); 8153 8154 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols. 8155 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) { 8156 IntersectionSet.erase( 8157 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(), 8158 IntersectionSet.end(), 8159 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool { 8160 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0; 8161 }), 8162 IntersectionSet.end()); 8163 } 8164 8165 // Sort the remaining protocols by name. 8166 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(), 8167 compareObjCProtocolsByName); 8168 } 8169 8170 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second. 8171 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs, 8172 QualType rhs) { 8173 // Common case: two object pointers. 8174 const auto *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 8175 const auto *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 8176 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT) 8177 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT); 8178 8179 // Two block pointers. 8180 const auto *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>(); 8181 const auto *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>(); 8182 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock) 8183 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs); 8184 8185 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's 8186 // acceptable. 8187 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) || 8188 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock)) 8189 return true; 8190 8191 return false; 8192 } 8193 8194 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent. 8195 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx, 8196 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface, 8197 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs, 8198 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs, 8199 bool stripKindOf) { 8200 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size()) 8201 return false; 8202 8203 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList(); 8204 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) { 8205 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i])) 8206 continue; 8207 8208 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) { 8209 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant: 8210 if (!stripKindOf || 8211 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx), 8212 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) { 8213 return false; 8214 } 8215 break; 8216 8217 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant: 8218 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i])) 8219 return false; 8220 break; 8221 8222 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant: 8223 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i])) 8224 return false; 8225 break; 8226 } 8227 } 8228 8229 return true; 8230 } 8231 8232 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible( 8233 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr, 8234 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) { 8235 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType(); 8236 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType(); 8237 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface(); 8238 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface(); 8239 8240 if (!LDecl || !RDecl) 8241 return {}; 8242 8243 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type. 8244 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return 8245 // kindof(A). 8246 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType(); 8247 8248 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a 8249 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it. 8250 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4> 8251 LHSAncestors; 8252 while (true) { 8253 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the 8254 // path from the LHS to the root. 8255 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS; 8256 8257 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) { 8258 // Get the type arguments. 8259 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten(); 8260 bool anyChanges = false; 8261 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) { 8262 // Both have type arguments, compare them. 8263 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 8264 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(), 8265 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) 8266 return {}; 8267 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) { 8268 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type 8269 // arguments. 8270 LHSTypeArgs = {}; 8271 anyChanges = true; 8272 } 8273 8274 // Compute the intersection of protocols. 8275 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols; 8276 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr, 8277 Protocols); 8278 if (!Protocols.empty()) 8279 anyChanges = true; 8280 8281 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type. 8282 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we 8283 // build a new result type. 8284 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) { 8285 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface()); 8286 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols, 8287 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType()); 8288 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result); 8289 } 8290 8291 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0)); 8292 } 8293 8294 // Find the superclass. 8295 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType(); 8296 if (LHSSuperType.isNull()) 8297 break; 8298 8299 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 8300 } 8301 8302 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check 8303 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors. 8304 while (true) { 8305 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()); 8306 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) { 8307 LHS = KnownLHS->second; 8308 8309 // Get the type arguments. 8310 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten(); 8311 bool anyChanges = false; 8312 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) { 8313 // Both have type arguments, compare them. 8314 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 8315 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(), 8316 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) 8317 return {}; 8318 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) { 8319 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type 8320 // arguments. 8321 RHSTypeArgs = {}; 8322 anyChanges = true; 8323 } 8324 8325 // Compute the intersection of protocols. 8326 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols; 8327 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr, 8328 Protocols); 8329 if (!Protocols.empty()) 8330 anyChanges = true; 8331 8332 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we 8333 // build a new result type. 8334 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) { 8335 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface()); 8336 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols, 8337 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType()); 8338 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result); 8339 } 8340 8341 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0)); 8342 } 8343 8344 // Find the superclass of the RHS. 8345 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType(); 8346 if (RHSSuperType.isNull()) 8347 break; 8348 8349 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 8350 } 8351 8352 return {}; 8353 } 8354 8355 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS, 8356 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) { 8357 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type"); 8358 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type"); 8359 8360 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of 8361 // the LHS. 8362 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface(); 8363 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()); 8364 if (!IsSuperClass) 8365 return false; 8366 8367 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are 8368 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the 8369 // LHS). 8370 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) { 8371 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types 8372 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols 8373 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok. 8374 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>. 8375 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols; 8376 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols); 8377 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's 8378 // qualifiers. 8379 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) 8380 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols); 8381 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match. 8382 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty()) 8383 return false; 8384 8385 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) { 8386 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false; 8387 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) 8388 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) { 8389 SuperImplementsProtocol = true; 8390 break; 8391 } 8392 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol) 8393 return false; 8394 } 8395 } 8396 8397 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments. 8398 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) { 8399 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the 8400 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through. 8401 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS; 8402 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface)) 8403 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 8404 8405 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments. 8406 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() && 8407 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(), 8408 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(), 8409 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) { 8410 return false; 8411 } 8412 } 8413 8414 return true; 8415 } 8416 8417 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 8418 // get the "pointed to" types 8419 const auto *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 8420 const auto *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 8421 8422 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT) 8423 return false; 8424 8425 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) || 8426 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT); 8427 } 8428 8429 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) { 8430 return canAssignObjCInterfaces( 8431 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 8432 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()); 8433 } 8434 8435 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible, 8436 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type. 8437 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the 8438 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules. 8439 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS, 8440 bool CompareUnqualified) { 8441 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8442 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS); 8443 8444 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull(); 8445 } 8446 8447 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 8448 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS); 8449 } 8450 8451 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 8452 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull(); 8453 } 8454 8455 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member 8456 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return 8457 /// QualType() 8458 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType, 8459 bool OfBlockPointer, 8460 bool Unqualified) { 8461 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) { 8462 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 8463 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) { 8464 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) { 8465 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8466 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 8467 if (!MT.isNull()) 8468 return MT; 8469 } 8470 } 8471 } 8472 8473 return {}; 8474 } 8475 8476 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function 8477 /// parameter types 8478 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 8479 bool OfBlockPointer, 8480 bool Unqualified) { 8481 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function 8482 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other 8483 // type is compatible with a union member 8484 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, 8485 Unqualified); 8486 if (!lmerge.isNull()) 8487 return lmerge; 8488 8489 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer, 8490 Unqualified); 8491 if (!rmerge.isNull()) 8492 return rmerge; 8493 8494 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 8495 } 8496 8497 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs, 8498 bool OfBlockPointer, 8499 bool Unqualified) { 8500 const auto *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>(); 8501 const auto *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>(); 8502 const auto *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase); 8503 const auto *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase); 8504 bool allLTypes = true; 8505 bool allRTypes = true; 8506 8507 // Check return type 8508 QualType retType; 8509 if (OfBlockPointer) { 8510 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType(); 8511 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType(); 8512 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified; 8513 if (!UnqualifiedResult) 8514 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()); 8515 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true); 8516 } 8517 else 8518 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false, 8519 Unqualified); 8520 if (retType.isNull()) 8521 return {}; 8522 8523 if (Unqualified) 8524 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8525 8526 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType()); 8527 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType()); 8528 if (Unqualified) { 8529 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8530 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8531 } 8532 8533 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType) 8534 allLTypes = false; 8535 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType) 8536 allRTypes = false; 8537 8538 // FIXME: double check this 8539 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 && 8540 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 && 8541 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()? 8542 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo(); 8543 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo(); 8544 8545 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions 8546 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC()) 8547 return {}; 8548 8549 // Regparm is part of the calling convention. 8550 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm()) 8551 return {}; 8552 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm()) 8553 return {}; 8554 8555 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult()) 8556 return {}; 8557 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) 8558 return {}; 8559 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck() != rbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck()) 8560 return {}; 8561 8562 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'. 8563 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn(); 8564 8565 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn) 8566 allLTypes = false; 8567 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn) 8568 allRTypes = false; 8569 8570 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn); 8571 8572 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes 8573 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() && 8574 "C++ shouldn't be here"); 8575 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters 8576 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams()) 8577 return {}; 8578 8579 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible 8580 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic()) 8581 return {}; 8582 8583 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals()) 8584 return {}; 8585 8586 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos; 8587 bool canUseLeft, canUseRight; 8588 if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight, 8589 newParamInfos)) 8590 return {}; 8591 8592 if (!canUseLeft) 8593 allLTypes = false; 8594 if (!canUseRight) 8595 allRTypes = false; 8596 8597 // Check parameter type compatibility 8598 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types; 8599 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) { 8600 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType(); 8601 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType(); 8602 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes( 8603 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 8604 if (paramType.isNull()) 8605 return {}; 8606 8607 if (Unqualified) 8608 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8609 8610 types.push_back(paramType); 8611 if (Unqualified) { 8612 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8613 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8614 } 8615 8616 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType)) 8617 allLTypes = false; 8618 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType)) 8619 allRTypes = false; 8620 } 8621 8622 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 8623 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 8624 8625 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo(); 8626 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo; 8627 EPI.ExtParameterInfos = 8628 newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data(); 8629 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI); 8630 } 8631 8632 if (lproto) allRTypes = false; 8633 if (rproto) allLTypes = false; 8634 8635 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto; 8636 if (proto) { 8637 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here"); 8638 if (proto->isVariadic()) 8639 return {}; 8640 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that 8641 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15). 8642 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer 8643 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different 8644 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible. 8645 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) { 8646 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i); 8647 8648 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used 8649 // to pass enum values. 8650 if (const auto *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) { 8651 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 8652 if (paramTy.isNull()) 8653 return {}; 8654 } 8655 8656 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() || 8657 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy) 8658 return {}; 8659 } 8660 8661 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 8662 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 8663 8664 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo(); 8665 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo; 8666 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI); 8667 } 8668 8669 if (allLTypes) return lhs; 8670 if (allRTypes) return rhs; 8671 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo); 8672 } 8673 8674 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them. 8675 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET, 8676 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) { 8677 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char, 8678 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type. 8679 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion 8680 // type. 8681 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 8682 if (underlyingType.isNull()) 8683 return {}; 8684 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other)) 8685 return other; 8686 8687 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any 8688 // integral type of the same size. 8689 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() && 8690 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other)) 8691 return other; 8692 8693 return {}; 8694 } 8695 8696 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS, 8697 bool OfBlockPointer, 8698 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) { 8699 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the 8700 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression 8701 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the 8702 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and 8703 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses). 8704 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?"); 8705 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?"); 8706 8707 if (Unqualified) { 8708 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 8709 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 8710 } 8711 8712 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS), 8713 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS); 8714 8715 // If two types are identical, they are compatible. 8716 if (LHSCan == RHSCan) 8717 return LHS; 8718 8719 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly. 8720 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 8721 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 8722 if (LQuals != RQuals) { 8723 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type 8724 // mismatch. 8725 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() || 8726 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() || 8727 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() || 8728 LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned()) 8729 return {}; 8730 8731 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is 8732 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective 8733 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix 8734 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually 8735 // qualified __strong. 8736 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 8737 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 8738 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements"); 8739 8740 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak) 8741 return {}; 8742 8743 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8744 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong)); 8745 } 8746 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8747 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS); 8748 } 8749 return {}; 8750 } 8751 8752 // Okay, qualifiers are equal. 8753 8754 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass(); 8755 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass(); 8756 8757 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these 8758 // comparisons, just force one to the other. 8759 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto; 8760 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto; 8761 8762 // Same as above for arrays 8763 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray) 8764 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray; 8765 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray) 8766 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray; 8767 8768 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects. 8769 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject; 8770 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject; 8771 8772 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector. 8773 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector; 8774 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector; 8775 8776 // If the canonical type classes don't match. 8777 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) { 8778 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum 8779 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa. 8780 if (const auto *ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) { 8781 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false); 8782 } 8783 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) { 8784 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType); 8785 } 8786 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type. 8787 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) { 8788 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType()) 8789 return LHS; 8790 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType()) 8791 return RHS; 8792 } 8793 8794 return {}; 8795 } 8796 8797 // The canonical type classes match. 8798 switch (LHSClass) { 8799 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 8800 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 8801 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 8802 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 8803 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 8804 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 8805 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here"); 8806 8807 case Type::Auto: 8808 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 8809 case Type::LValueReference: 8810 case Type::RValueReference: 8811 case Type::MemberPointer: 8812 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes"); 8813 8814 case Type::ObjCInterface: 8815 case Type::IncompleteArray: 8816 case Type::VariableArray: 8817 case Type::FunctionProto: 8818 case Type::ExtVector: 8819 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above"); 8820 8821 case Type::Pointer: 8822 { 8823 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 8824 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8825 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8826 if (Unqualified) { 8827 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 8828 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 8829 } 8830 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false, 8831 Unqualified); 8832 if (ResultType.isNull()) 8833 return {}; 8834 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8835 return LHS; 8836 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8837 return RHS; 8838 return getPointerType(ResultType); 8839 } 8840 case Type::BlockPointer: 8841 { 8842 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 8843 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8844 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8845 if (Unqualified) { 8846 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 8847 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 8848 } 8849 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8850 Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers(); 8851 Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers(); 8852 // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0 8853 // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric. 8854 if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual)) 8855 return {}; 8856 LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace(); 8857 RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace(); 8858 LHSPointee = 8859 QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue()); 8860 RHSPointee = 8861 QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue()); 8862 } 8863 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer, 8864 Unqualified); 8865 if (ResultType.isNull()) 8866 return {}; 8867 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8868 return LHS; 8869 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8870 return RHS; 8871 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType); 8872 } 8873 case Type::Atomic: 8874 { 8875 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info 8876 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(); 8877 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(); 8878 if (Unqualified) { 8879 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType(); 8880 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType(); 8881 } 8882 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false, 8883 Unqualified); 8884 if (ResultType.isNull()) 8885 return {}; 8886 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8887 return LHS; 8888 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8889 return RHS; 8890 return getAtomicType(ResultType); 8891 } 8892 case Type::ConstantArray: 8893 { 8894 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS); 8895 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS); 8896 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize()) 8897 return {}; 8898 8899 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType(); 8900 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType(); 8901 if (Unqualified) { 8902 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType(); 8903 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType(); 8904 } 8905 8906 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified); 8907 if (ResultType.isNull()) 8908 return {}; 8909 8910 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS); 8911 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS); 8912 8913 // If either side is a variable array, and both are complete, check whether 8914 // the current dimension is definite. 8915 if (LVAT || RVAT) { 8916 auto SizeFetch = [this](const VariableArrayType* VAT, 8917 const ConstantArrayType* CAT) 8918 -> std::pair<bool,llvm::APInt> { 8919 if (VAT) { 8920 llvm::APSInt TheInt; 8921 Expr *E = VAT->getSizeExpr(); 8922 if (E && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(TheInt, *this)) 8923 return std::make_pair(true, TheInt); 8924 else 8925 return std::make_pair(false, TheInt); 8926 } else if (CAT) { 8927 return std::make_pair(true, CAT->getSize()); 8928 } else { 8929 return std::make_pair(false, llvm::APInt()); 8930 } 8931 }; 8932 8933 bool HaveLSize, HaveRSize; 8934 llvm::APInt LSize, RSize; 8935 std::tie(HaveLSize, LSize) = SizeFetch(LVAT, LCAT); 8936 std::tie(HaveRSize, RSize) = SizeFetch(RVAT, RCAT); 8937 if (HaveLSize && HaveRSize && !llvm::APInt::isSameValue(LSize, RSize)) 8938 return {}; // Definite, but unequal, array dimension 8939 } 8940 8941 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8942 return LHS; 8943 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8944 return RHS; 8945 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(), 8946 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 8947 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(), 8948 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 8949 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8950 return LHS; 8951 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) 8952 return RHS; 8953 if (LVAT) { 8954 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because 8955 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type 8956 // has to be different. 8957 return LHS; 8958 } 8959 if (RVAT) { 8960 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because 8961 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type 8962 // has to be different. 8963 return RHS; 8964 } 8965 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS; 8966 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS; 8967 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType, 8968 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0); 8969 } 8970 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 8971 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified); 8972 case Type::Record: 8973 case Type::Enum: 8974 return {}; 8975 case Type::Builtin: 8976 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above. 8977 return {}; 8978 case Type::Complex: 8979 // Distinct complex types are incompatible. 8980 return {}; 8981 case Type::Vector: 8982 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector! 8983 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(), 8984 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>())) 8985 return LHS; 8986 return {}; 8987 case Type::ObjCObject: { 8988 // Check if the types are assignment compatible. 8989 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether 8990 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal. 8991 const auto *LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 8992 const auto *RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); 8993 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface)) 8994 return LHS; 8995 8996 return {}; 8997 } 8998 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 8999 if (OfBlockPointer) { 9000 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer( 9001 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 9002 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 9003 BlockReturnType)) 9004 return LHS; 9005 return {}; 9006 } 9007 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 9008 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())) 9009 return LHS; 9010 9011 return {}; 9012 case Type::Pipe: 9013 assert(LHS != RHS && 9014 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!"); 9015 return {}; 9016 } 9017 9018 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!"); 9019 } 9020 9021 bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo( 9022 const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType, 9023 bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond, 9024 SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) { 9025 assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty"); 9026 CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true; 9027 bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos(); 9028 bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos(); 9029 9030 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos, 9031 // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them. 9032 if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo) 9033 return true; 9034 9035 bool NeedParamInfo = false; 9036 size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size() 9037 : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size(); 9038 9039 for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) { 9040 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam; 9041 if (FirstHasInfo) 9042 FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I); 9043 if (SecondHasInfo) 9044 SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I); 9045 9046 // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches. 9047 if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false)) 9048 return false; 9049 9050 bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape(); 9051 bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape(); 9052 bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape; 9053 NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape)); 9054 if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue()) 9055 NeedParamInfo = true; 9056 if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape) 9057 CanUseFirst = false; 9058 if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape) 9059 CanUseSecond = false; 9060 } 9061 9062 if (!NeedParamInfo) 9063 NewParamInfos.clear(); 9064 9065 return true; 9066 } 9067 9068 void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) { 9069 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr; 9070 } 9071 9072 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and 9073 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function 9074 /// return types. 9075 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) { 9076 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS), 9077 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS); 9078 // If two types are identical, they are compatible. 9079 if (LHSCan == RHSCan) 9080 return LHS; 9081 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) { 9082 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType()) 9083 return {}; 9084 QualType OldReturnType = 9085 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType(); 9086 QualType NewReturnType = 9087 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType(); 9088 QualType ResReturnType = 9089 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType); 9090 if (ResReturnType.isNull()) 9091 return {}; 9092 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) { 9093 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo(); 9094 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type. 9095 const auto *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>(); 9096 if (const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) { 9097 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 9098 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS); 9099 QualType ResultType = 9100 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 9101 return ResultType; 9102 } 9103 } 9104 return {}; 9105 } 9106 9107 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged. 9108 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 9109 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers(); 9110 if (LQuals != RQuals) { 9111 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch. 9112 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() || 9113 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace()) 9114 return {}; 9115 9116 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is 9117 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective 9118 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix 9119 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually 9120 // qualified __strong. 9121 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 9122 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr(); 9123 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements"); 9124 9125 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak) 9126 return {}; 9127 9128 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong) 9129 return LHS; 9130 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong) 9131 return RHS; 9132 return {}; 9133 } 9134 9135 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9136 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 9137 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 9138 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT); 9139 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT) 9140 return LHS; 9141 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT) 9142 return RHS; 9143 } 9144 return {}; 9145 } 9146 9147 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9148 // Integer Predicates 9149 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9150 9151 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const { 9152 if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 9153 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 9154 if (T->isBooleanType()) 9155 return 1; 9156 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method 9157 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T); 9158 } 9159 9160 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const { 9161 assert((T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() || T->isSignedFixedPointType()) && 9162 "Unexpected type"); 9163 9164 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int> 9165 if (const auto *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>()) 9166 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()), 9167 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind()); 9168 9169 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type. 9170 if (const auto *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 9171 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 9172 9173 const auto *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 9174 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer or fixed point type"); 9175 switch (BTy->getKind()) { 9176 case BuiltinType::Char_S: 9177 case BuiltinType::SChar: 9178 return UnsignedCharTy; 9179 case BuiltinType::Short: 9180 return UnsignedShortTy; 9181 case BuiltinType::Int: 9182 return UnsignedIntTy; 9183 case BuiltinType::Long: 9184 return UnsignedLongTy; 9185 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 9186 return UnsignedLongLongTy; 9187 case BuiltinType::Int128: 9188 return UnsignedInt128Ty; 9189 9190 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 9191 return UnsignedShortAccumTy; 9192 case BuiltinType::Accum: 9193 return UnsignedAccumTy; 9194 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 9195 return UnsignedLongAccumTy; 9196 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 9197 return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy; 9198 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 9199 return SatUnsignedAccumTy; 9200 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 9201 return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy; 9202 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 9203 return UnsignedShortFractTy; 9204 case BuiltinType::Fract: 9205 return UnsignedFractTy; 9206 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 9207 return UnsignedLongFractTy; 9208 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 9209 return SatUnsignedShortFractTy; 9210 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 9211 return SatUnsignedFractTy; 9212 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 9213 return SatUnsignedLongFractTy; 9214 default: 9215 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer or fixed point type"); 9216 } 9217 } 9218 9219 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default; 9220 9221 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD, 9222 QualType ReturnType) {} 9223 9224 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9225 // Builtin Type Computation 9226 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9227 9228 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the 9229 /// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If 9230 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic 9231 /// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of 9232 /// a vector of "i*". 9233 /// 9234 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required 9235 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression. 9236 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context, 9237 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, 9238 bool &RequiresICE, 9239 bool AllowTypeModifiers) { 9240 // Modifiers. 9241 int HowLong = 0; 9242 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false; 9243 RequiresICE = false; 9244 9245 // Read the prefixed modifiers first. 9246 bool Done = false; 9247 #ifndef NDEBUG 9248 bool IsSpecialLong = false; 9249 #endif 9250 while (!Done) { 9251 switch (*Str++) { 9252 default: Done = true; --Str; break; 9253 case 'I': 9254 RequiresICE = true; 9255 break; 9256 case 'S': 9257 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!"); 9258 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!"); 9259 Signed = true; 9260 break; 9261 case 'U': 9262 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!"); 9263 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!"); 9264 Unsigned = true; 9265 break; 9266 case 'L': 9267 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use 'L' with 'W' or 'N' modifiers"); 9268 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier"); 9269 ++HowLong; 9270 break; 9271 case 'N': 9272 // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise. 9273 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!"); 9274 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!"); 9275 #ifndef NDEBUG 9276 IsSpecialLong = true; 9277 #endif 9278 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32) 9279 ++HowLong; 9280 break; 9281 case 'W': 9282 // This modifier represents int64 type. 9283 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!"); 9284 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!"); 9285 #ifndef NDEBUG 9286 IsSpecialLong = true; 9287 #endif 9288 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) { 9289 default: 9290 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type"); 9291 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: 9292 HowLong = 1; 9293 break; 9294 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: 9295 HowLong = 2; 9296 break; 9297 } 9298 break; 9299 } 9300 } 9301 9302 QualType Type; 9303 9304 // Read the base type. 9305 switch (*Str++) { 9306 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!"); 9307 case 'v': 9308 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 9309 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!"); 9310 Type = Context.VoidTy; 9311 break; 9312 case 'h': 9313 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 9314 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!"); 9315 Type = Context.HalfTy; 9316 break; 9317 case 'f': 9318 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 9319 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!"); 9320 Type = Context.FloatTy; 9321 break; 9322 case 'd': 9323 assert(HowLong < 3 && !Signed && !Unsigned && 9324 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!"); 9325 if (HowLong == 1) 9326 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy; 9327 else if (HowLong == 2) 9328 Type = Context.Float128Ty; 9329 else 9330 Type = Context.DoubleTy; 9331 break; 9332 case 's': 9333 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!"); 9334 if (Unsigned) 9335 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 9336 else 9337 Type = Context.ShortTy; 9338 break; 9339 case 'i': 9340 if (HowLong == 3) 9341 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty; 9342 else if (HowLong == 2) 9343 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 9344 else if (HowLong == 1) 9345 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 9346 else 9347 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 9348 break; 9349 case 'c': 9350 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!"); 9351 if (Signed) 9352 Type = Context.SignedCharTy; 9353 else if (Unsigned) 9354 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 9355 else 9356 Type = Context.CharTy; 9357 break; 9358 case 'b': // boolean 9359 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!"); 9360 Type = Context.BoolTy; 9361 break; 9362 case 'z': // size_t. 9363 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!"); 9364 Type = Context.getSizeType(); 9365 break; 9366 case 'w': // wchar_t. 9367 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!"); 9368 Type = Context.getWideCharType(); 9369 break; 9370 case 'F': 9371 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType(); 9372 break; 9373 case 'G': 9374 Type = Context.getObjCIdType(); 9375 break; 9376 case 'H': 9377 Type = Context.getObjCSelType(); 9378 break; 9379 case 'M': 9380 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType(); 9381 break; 9382 case 'a': 9383 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 9384 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!"); 9385 break; 9386 case 'A': 9387 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly 9388 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two 9389 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones 9390 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is 9391 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list 9392 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86, 9393 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want 9394 // it to be a __va_list_tag*. 9395 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 9396 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!"); 9397 if (Type->isArrayType()) 9398 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type); 9399 else 9400 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type); 9401 break; 9402 case 'V': { 9403 char *End; 9404 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 9405 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size"); 9406 Str = End; 9407 9408 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, 9409 RequiresICE, false); 9410 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE"); 9411 9412 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet. 9413 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements, 9414 VectorType::GenericVector); 9415 break; 9416 } 9417 case 'E': { 9418 char *End; 9419 9420 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 9421 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size"); 9422 9423 Str = End; 9424 9425 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE, 9426 false); 9427 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements); 9428 break; 9429 } 9430 case 'X': { 9431 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE, 9432 false); 9433 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE"); 9434 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType); 9435 break; 9436 } 9437 case 'Y': 9438 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType(); 9439 break; 9440 case 'P': 9441 Type = Context.getFILEType(); 9442 if (Type.isNull()) { 9443 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio; 9444 return {}; 9445 } 9446 break; 9447 case 'J': 9448 if (Signed) 9449 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType(); 9450 else 9451 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType(); 9452 9453 if (Type.isNull()) { 9454 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp; 9455 return {}; 9456 } 9457 break; 9458 case 'K': 9459 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!"); 9460 Type = Context.getucontext_tType(); 9461 9462 if (Type.isNull()) { 9463 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext; 9464 return {}; 9465 } 9466 break; 9467 case 'p': 9468 Type = Context.getProcessIDType(); 9469 break; 9470 } 9471 9472 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it. 9473 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers; 9474 while (!Done) { 9475 switch (char c = *Str++) { 9476 default: Done = true; --Str; break; 9477 case '*': 9478 case '&': { 9479 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types 9480 // qualified with an address space. 9481 char *End; 9482 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10); 9483 if (End != Str) { 9484 // Note AddrSpace == 0 is not the same as an unspecified address space. 9485 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType( 9486 Type, 9487 Context.getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(AddrSpace)); 9488 Str = End; 9489 } 9490 if (c == '*') 9491 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type); 9492 else 9493 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type); 9494 break; 9495 } 9496 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg. 9497 case 'C': 9498 Type = Type.withConst(); 9499 break; 9500 case 'D': 9501 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type); 9502 break; 9503 case 'R': 9504 Type = Type.withRestrict(); 9505 break; 9506 } 9507 } 9508 9509 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) && 9510 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer"); 9511 9512 return Type; 9513 } 9514 9515 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin. 9516 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id, 9517 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, 9518 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const { 9519 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id); 9520 9521 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 9522 9523 bool RequiresICE = false; 9524 Error = GE_None; 9525 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, 9526 RequiresICE, true); 9527 if (Error != GE_None) 9528 return {}; 9529 9530 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE"); 9531 9532 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') { 9533 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true); 9534 if (Error != GE_None) 9535 return {}; 9536 9537 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the 9538 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return. 9539 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs) 9540 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size(); 9541 9542 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type. 9543 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 9544 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 9545 9546 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty); 9547 } 9548 9549 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo) 9550 return {}; 9551 9552 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) && 9553 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!"); 9554 9555 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C); 9556 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true); 9557 9558 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.'); 9559 9560 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here. 9561 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9562 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI); 9563 9564 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 9565 EPI.ExtInfo = EI; 9566 EPI.Variadic = Variadic; 9567 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id)) 9568 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = 9569 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone; 9570 9571 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI); 9572 } 9573 9574 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context, 9575 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9576 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 9577 return GVA_Internal; 9578 9579 // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every 9580 // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc. 9581 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 9582 if (!MD->isUserProvided()) 9583 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9584 9585 GVALinkage External; 9586 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) { 9587 case TSK_Undeclared: 9588 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization: 9589 External = GVA_StrongExternal; 9590 break; 9591 9592 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition: 9593 return GVA_StrongODR; 9594 9595 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10: 9596 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of 9597 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly 9598 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for 9599 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be 9600 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ] 9601 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration: 9602 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 9603 9604 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation: 9605 External = GVA_DiscardableODR; 9606 break; 9607 } 9608 9609 if (!FD->isInlined()) 9610 return External; 9611 9612 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 9613 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 9614 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) || 9615 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 9616 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions. 9617 9618 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be 9619 // externally visible. 9620 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible()) 9621 return External; 9622 9623 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible. 9624 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 9625 } 9626 9627 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode 9628 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later 9629 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded. 9630 if (FD->isMSExternInline()) 9631 return GVA_StrongODR; 9632 9633 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9634 } 9635 9636 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context, 9637 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) { 9638 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx 9639 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions. 9640 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) { 9641 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR) 9642 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 9643 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 9644 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR) 9645 return GVA_StrongODR; 9646 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && 9647 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) { 9648 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be 9649 // visible externally so they can be launched from host. 9650 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal) 9651 return GVA_StrongODR; 9652 } 9653 return L; 9654 } 9655 9656 /// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source 9657 /// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration. 9658 static GVALinkage 9659 adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D, 9660 GVALinkage L) { 9661 ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource(); 9662 if (!Source) 9663 return L; 9664 9665 switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) { 9666 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never: 9667 // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition. 9668 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR) 9669 return GVA_StrongODR; 9670 break; 9671 9672 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always: 9673 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 9674 9675 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy: 9676 break; 9677 } 9678 return L; 9679 } 9680 9681 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const { 9682 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD, 9683 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD, 9684 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD))); 9685 } 9686 9687 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context, 9688 const VarDecl *VD) { 9689 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible()) 9690 return GVA_Internal; 9691 9692 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) { 9693 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod(); 9694 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext)) 9695 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent(); 9696 9697 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl 9698 // LexicalContext. 9699 if (!LexicalContext) 9700 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9701 9702 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the 9703 // nearest enclosing function. 9704 auto StaticLocalLinkage = 9705 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext)); 9706 9707 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must 9708 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it 9709 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line." 9710 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use 9711 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are 9712 // known/supported currently. 9713 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR || 9714 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally) 9715 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9716 return StaticLocalLinkage; 9717 } 9718 9719 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions. 9720 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't 9721 // cause link errors. 9722 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD)) 9723 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9724 9725 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are 9726 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr. 9727 GVALinkage StrongLinkage; 9728 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) { 9729 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None: 9730 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal; 9731 break; 9732 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak: 9733 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown: 9734 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR; 9735 break; 9736 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong: 9737 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR; 9738 break; 9739 } 9740 9741 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) { 9742 case TSK_Undeclared: 9743 return StrongLinkage; 9744 9745 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization: 9746 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 9747 VD->isStaticDataMember() 9748 ? GVA_StrongODR 9749 : StrongLinkage; 9750 9751 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition: 9752 return GVA_StrongODR; 9753 9754 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration: 9755 return GVA_AvailableExternally; 9756 9757 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation: 9758 return GVA_DiscardableODR; 9759 } 9760 9761 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!"); 9762 } 9763 9764 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) { 9765 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD, 9766 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD, 9767 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD))); 9768 } 9769 9770 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) { 9771 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 9772 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl()) 9773 return false; 9774 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted. 9775 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register) 9776 return false; 9777 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 9778 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 9779 return false; 9780 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 9781 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template. 9782 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 9783 return false; 9784 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D)) 9785 return true; 9786 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D)) 9787 return true; 9788 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D)) 9789 return true; 9790 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D)) 9791 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext(); 9792 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D)) 9793 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext(); 9794 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D)) 9795 return true; 9796 else 9797 return false; 9798 9799 if (D->isFromASTFile() && !LangOpts.BuildingPCHWithObjectFile) { 9800 assert(getExternalSource() && "It's from an AST file; must have a source."); 9801 // On Windows, PCH files are built together with an object file. If this 9802 // declaration comes from such a PCH and DeclMustBeEmitted would return 9803 // true, it would have returned true and the decl would have been emitted 9804 // into that object file, so it doesn't need to be emitted here. 9805 // Note that decls are still emitted if they're referenced, as usual; 9806 // DeclMustBeEmitted is used to decide whether a decl must be emitted even 9807 // if it's not referenced. 9808 // 9809 // Explicit template instantiation definitions are tricky. If there was an 9810 // explicit template instantiation decl in the PCH before, it will look like 9811 // the definition comes from there, even if that was just the declaration. 9812 // (Explicit instantiation defs of variable templates always get emitted.) 9813 bool IsExpInstDef = 9814 isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 9815 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == 9816 TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition; 9817 9818 // Implicit member function definitions, such as operator= might not be 9819 // marked as template specializations, since they're not coming from a 9820 // template but synthesized directly on the class. 9821 IsExpInstDef |= 9822 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D) && 9823 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->getParent()->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == 9824 TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition; 9825 9826 if (getExternalSource()->DeclIsFromPCHWithObjectFile(D) && !IsExpInstDef) 9827 return false; 9828 } 9829 9830 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it. 9831 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 9832 return false; 9833 9834 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves. 9835 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) 9836 return false; 9837 9838 // Aliases and used decls are required. 9839 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9840 return true; 9841 9842 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 9843 // Multiversioned functions always have to be emitted, because they are used 9844 // by the resolver. 9845 if (FD->isMultiVersion()) 9846 return true; 9847 // Forward declarations aren't required. 9848 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 9849 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition(); 9850 9851 // Constructors and destructors are required. 9852 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) 9853 return true; 9854 9855 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes 9856 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though. 9857 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 9858 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 9859 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent(); 9860 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) { 9861 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD); 9862 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl()) 9863 return true; 9864 } 9865 } 9866 } 9867 9868 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD); 9869 9870 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can 9871 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++. 9872 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++. 9873 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage); 9874 } 9875 9876 const auto *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D); 9877 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var"); 9878 9879 // If the decl is marked as `declare target to`, it should be emitted for the 9880 // host and for the device. 9881 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && 9882 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(VD)) 9883 return true; 9884 9885 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 9886 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD)) 9887 return false; 9888 9889 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required. 9890 auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD); 9891 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage)) 9892 return true; 9893 9894 // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU. 9895 if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally) 9896 return false; 9897 9898 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required. 9899 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType()) 9900 return true; 9901 9902 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required. 9903 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) && 9904 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery. 9905 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 9906 return true; 9907 9908 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their 9909 // bindings have side-effects. 9910 if (const auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD)) 9911 for (const auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 9912 if (const auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar()) 9913 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD)) 9914 return true; 9915 9916 return false; 9917 } 9918 9919 void ASTContext::forEachMultiversionedFunctionVersion( 9920 const FunctionDecl *FD, 9921 llvm::function_ref<void(FunctionDecl *)> Pred) const { 9922 assert(FD->isMultiVersion() && "Only valid for multiversioned functions"); 9923 llvm::SmallDenseSet<const FunctionDecl*, 4> SeenDecls; 9924 FD = FD->getCanonicalDecl(); 9925 for (auto *CurDecl : 9926 FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->lookup(FD->getDeclName())) { 9927 FunctionDecl *CurFD = CurDecl->getAsFunction()->getCanonicalDecl(); 9928 if (CurFD && hasSameType(CurFD->getType(), FD->getType()) && 9929 std::end(SeenDecls) == llvm::find(SeenDecls, CurFD)) { 9930 SeenDecls.insert(CurFD); 9931 Pred(CurFD); 9932 } 9933 } 9934 } 9935 9936 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic, 9937 bool IsCXXMethod) const { 9938 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object 9939 if (IsCXXMethod) 9940 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic); 9941 9942 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) { 9943 case LangOptions::DCC_None: 9944 break; 9945 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl: 9946 return CC_C; 9947 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall: 9948 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic) 9949 return CC_X86FastCall; 9950 break; 9951 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall: 9952 if (!IsVariadic) 9953 return CC_X86StdCall; 9954 break; 9955 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall: 9956 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions. 9957 if (!IsVariadic) 9958 return CC_X86VectorCall; 9959 break; 9960 case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall: 9961 // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions. 9962 if (!IsVariadic) 9963 return CC_X86RegCall; 9964 break; 9965 } 9966 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown); 9967 } 9968 9969 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const { 9970 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object 9971 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD); 9972 } 9973 9974 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() { 9975 if (!VTContext.get()) { 9976 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9977 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this)); 9978 else 9979 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this)); 9980 } 9981 return VTContext.get(); 9982 } 9983 9984 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() { 9985 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) { 9986 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: 9987 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium: 9988 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: 9989 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS: 9990 case TargetCXXABI::iOS: 9991 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64: 9992 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly: 9993 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS: 9994 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics()); 9995 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft: 9996 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics()); 9997 } 9998 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI"); 9999 } 10000 10001 CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default; 10002 10003 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const { 10004 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() + 10005 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) + 10006 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) + 10007 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) + 10008 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) + 10009 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) + 10010 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) + 10011 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) + 10012 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) + 10013 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) + 10014 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) + 10015 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) + 10016 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) + 10017 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern); 10018 } 10019 10020 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth - 10021 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details: 10022 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned. 10023 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types. 10024 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth, 10025 unsigned Signed) const { 10026 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed); 10027 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty); 10028 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128) 10029 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty; 10030 return QualTy; 10031 } 10032 10033 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth - 10034 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth. 10035 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types. 10036 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const { 10037 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth); 10038 switch (Ty) { 10039 case TargetInfo::Float: 10040 return FloatTy; 10041 case TargetInfo::Double: 10042 return DoubleTy; 10043 case TargetInfo::LongDouble: 10044 return LongDoubleTy; 10045 case TargetInfo::Float128: 10046 return Float128Ty; 10047 case TargetInfo::NoFloat: 10048 return {}; 10049 } 10050 10051 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value"); 10052 } 10053 10054 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) { 10055 if (Number > 1) 10056 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number; 10057 } 10058 10059 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const { 10060 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND); 10061 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1; 10062 } 10063 10064 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) { 10065 if (Number > 1) 10066 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number; 10067 } 10068 10069 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const { 10070 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD); 10071 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1; 10072 } 10073 10074 MangleNumberingContext & 10075 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) { 10076 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C. 10077 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC]; 10078 if (!MCtx) 10079 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext(); 10080 return *MCtx; 10081 } 10082 10083 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> 10084 ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const { 10085 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext(); 10086 } 10087 10088 const CXXConstructorDecl * 10089 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 10090 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject( 10091 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl())); 10092 } 10093 10094 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD, 10095 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) { 10096 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject( 10097 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()), 10098 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl())); 10099 } 10100 10101 void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD, 10102 TypedefNameDecl *DD) { 10103 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD); 10104 } 10105 10106 TypedefNameDecl * 10107 ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) { 10108 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD); 10109 } 10110 10111 void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD, 10112 DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 10113 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD); 10114 } 10115 10116 DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) { 10117 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD); 10118 } 10119 10120 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) { 10121 ParamIndices[D] = index; 10122 } 10123 10124 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const { 10125 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D); 10126 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() && 10127 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl"); 10128 return I->second; 10129 } 10130 10131 APValue * 10132 ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E, 10133 bool MayCreate) { 10134 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static && 10135 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary"); 10136 if (MayCreate) { 10137 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E]; 10138 if (!MTVI) 10139 MTVI = new (*this) APValue; 10140 return MTVI; 10141 } 10142 10143 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E); 10144 } 10145 10146 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const { 10147 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 10148 if (!T.isOSDarwin()) 10149 return false; 10150 10151 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) && 10152 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9))) 10153 return false; 10154 10155 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 10156 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy); 10157 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity(); 10158 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy); 10159 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity(); 10160 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth(); 10161 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits); 10162 } 10163 10164 /// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs. 10165 /// @{ 10166 template <typename T> 10167 static ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) { 10168 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node); 10169 } 10170 template <> 10171 ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) { 10172 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node); 10173 } 10174 template <> 10175 ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode 10176 createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) { 10177 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node); 10178 } 10179 /// @} 10180 10181 /// A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their 10182 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor. 10183 /// 10184 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST 10185 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context) 10186 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers. 10187 /// 10188 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes. 10189 class ASTContext::ParentMap::ASTVisitor 10190 : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ASTVisitor> { 10191 public: 10192 ASTVisitor(ParentMap &Map) : Map(Map) {} 10193 10194 private: 10195 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ASTVisitor>; 10196 10197 using VisitorBase = RecursiveASTVisitor<ASTVisitor>; 10198 10199 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const { return true; } 10200 10201 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const { return true; } 10202 10203 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn, 10204 typename MapTy> 10205 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode, BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, 10206 MapTy *Parents) { 10207 if (!Node) 10208 return true; 10209 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) { 10210 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only 10211 // when no memoization data is available for the type. 10212 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template 10213 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to 10214 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create 10215 // new matches. 10216 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash 10217 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions / 10218 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that 10219 // do not have pointer identity. 10220 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode]; 10221 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) { 10222 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>()) 10223 NodeOrVector = D; 10224 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>()) 10225 NodeOrVector = S; 10226 else 10227 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back()); 10228 } else { 10229 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ParentVector *>()) { 10230 auto *Vector = new ParentVector( 10231 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector)); 10232 delete NodeOrVector 10233 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>(); 10234 NodeOrVector = Vector; 10235 } 10236 10237 auto *Vector = NodeOrVector.template get<ParentVector *>(); 10238 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data. 10239 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling 10240 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all 10241 // types. 10242 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() && 10243 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(), 10244 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end(); 10245 if (!Found) 10246 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back()); 10247 } 10248 } 10249 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node)); 10250 bool Result = BaseTraverse(); 10251 ParentStack.pop_back(); 10252 return Result; 10253 } 10254 10255 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) { 10256 return TraverseNode( 10257 DeclNode, DeclNode, [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); }, 10258 &Map.PointerParents); 10259 } 10260 10261 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) { 10262 return TraverseNode( 10263 StmtNode, StmtNode, [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); }, 10264 &Map.PointerParents); 10265 } 10266 10267 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) { 10268 return TraverseNode( 10269 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode), 10270 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); }, 10271 &Map.OtherParents); 10272 } 10273 10274 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) { 10275 return TraverseNode( 10276 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode), 10277 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode); }, 10278 &Map.OtherParents); 10279 } 10280 10281 ParentMap ⤅ 10282 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack; 10283 }; 10284 10285 ASTContext::ParentMap::ParentMap(ASTContext &Ctx) { 10286 ASTVisitor(*this).TraverseAST(Ctx); 10287 } 10288 10289 ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList 10290 ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) { 10291 if (!Parents) 10292 // We build the parent map for the traversal scope (usually whole TU), as 10293 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree. 10294 Parents = llvm::make_unique<ParentMap>(*this); 10295 return Parents->getParents(Node); 10296 } 10297 10298 bool 10299 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl, 10300 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) { 10301 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod. 10302 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() 10303 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) 10304 return false; 10305 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() != 10306 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier()) 10307 return false; 10308 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType())) 10309 return false; 10310 10311 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size()) 10312 return false; 10313 10314 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(), 10315 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(), 10316 EF = MethodDecl->param_end(); 10317 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) { 10318 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF); 10319 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM); 10320 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier()) 10321 return false; 10322 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType())) 10323 return false; 10324 } 10325 10326 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic()); 10327 } 10328 10329 uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const { 10330 LangAS AS; 10331 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType()) 10332 AS = LangAS::Default; 10333 else 10334 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 10335 10336 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS); 10337 } 10338 10339 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const { 10340 if (isTargetAddressSpace(AS)) 10341 return toTargetAddressSpace(AS); 10342 else 10343 return (*AddrSpaceMap)[(unsigned)AS]; 10344 } 10345 10346 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSaturatedType(QualType Ty) const { 10347 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10348 10349 if (Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType()) return Ty; 10350 10351 const auto &BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 10352 switch (BT->getKind()) { 10353 default: 10354 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!"); 10355 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 10356 return SatShortAccumTy; 10357 case BuiltinType::Accum: 10358 return SatAccumTy; 10359 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 10360 return SatLongAccumTy; 10361 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 10362 return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy; 10363 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 10364 return SatUnsignedAccumTy; 10365 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 10366 return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy; 10367 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 10368 return SatShortFractTy; 10369 case BuiltinType::Fract: 10370 return SatFractTy; 10371 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 10372 return SatLongFractTy; 10373 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 10374 return SatUnsignedShortFractTy; 10375 case BuiltinType::UFract: 10376 return SatUnsignedFractTy; 10377 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 10378 return SatUnsignedLongFractTy; 10379 } 10380 } 10381 10382 LangAS ASTContext::getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(unsigned AS) const { 10383 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) 10384 return getTargetInfo().getOpenCLBuiltinAddressSpace(AS); 10385 10386 if (LangOpts.CUDA) 10387 return getTargetInfo().getCUDABuiltinAddressSpace(AS); 10388 10389 return getLangASFromTargetAS(AS); 10390 } 10391 10392 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that 10393 // doesn't include ASTContext.h 10394 template 10395 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr< 10396 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType 10397 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr< 10398 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue( 10399 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value); 10400 10401 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointScale(QualType Ty) const { 10402 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10403 10404 const auto *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 10405 const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo(); 10406 switch (BT->getKind()) { 10407 default: 10408 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!"); 10409 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 10410 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 10411 return Target.getShortAccumScale(); 10412 case BuiltinType::Accum: 10413 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 10414 return Target.getAccumScale(); 10415 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 10416 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 10417 return Target.getLongAccumScale(); 10418 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 10419 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 10420 return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumScale(); 10421 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 10422 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 10423 return Target.getUnsignedAccumScale(); 10424 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 10425 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 10426 return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumScale(); 10427 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 10428 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 10429 return Target.getShortFractScale(); 10430 case BuiltinType::Fract: 10431 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 10432 return Target.getFractScale(); 10433 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 10434 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 10435 return Target.getLongFractScale(); 10436 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 10437 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 10438 return Target.getUnsignedShortFractScale(); 10439 case BuiltinType::UFract: 10440 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 10441 return Target.getUnsignedFractScale(); 10442 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 10443 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 10444 return Target.getUnsignedLongFractScale(); 10445 } 10446 } 10447 10448 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointIBits(QualType Ty) const { 10449 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10450 10451 const auto *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 10452 const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo(); 10453 switch (BT->getKind()) { 10454 default: 10455 llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!"); 10456 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 10457 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 10458 return Target.getShortAccumIBits(); 10459 case BuiltinType::Accum: 10460 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 10461 return Target.getAccumIBits(); 10462 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 10463 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 10464 return Target.getLongAccumIBits(); 10465 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 10466 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 10467 return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumIBits(); 10468 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 10469 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 10470 return Target.getUnsignedAccumIBits(); 10471 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 10472 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 10473 return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumIBits(); 10474 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 10475 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 10476 case BuiltinType::Fract: 10477 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 10478 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 10479 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 10480 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 10481 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 10482 case BuiltinType::UFract: 10483 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 10484 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 10485 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 10486 return 0; 10487 } 10488 } 10489 10490 FixedPointSemantics ASTContext::getFixedPointSemantics(QualType Ty) const { 10491 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10492 bool isSigned = Ty->isSignedFixedPointType(); 10493 return FixedPointSemantics( 10494 static_cast<unsigned>(getTypeSize(Ty)), getFixedPointScale(Ty), isSigned, 10495 Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType(), 10496 !isSigned && getTargetInfo().doUnsignedFixedPointTypesHavePadding()); 10497 } 10498 10499 APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMax(QualType Ty) const { 10500 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10501 return APFixedPoint::getMax(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty)); 10502 } 10503 10504 APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMin(QualType Ty) const { 10505 assert(Ty->isFixedPointType()); 10506 return APFixedPoint::getMin(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty)); 10507 } 10508